Fix drawing of relief rects on X and W32.
[bpt/emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
22
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <stdio.h>
25
26 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
27
28 #include "lisp.h"
29 #include "blockinput.h"
30 #include "syssignal.h"
31
32 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
33 if this is not done before the other system files. */
34 #include "xterm.h"
35 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
36
37 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
38 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
39 #ifndef makedev
40 #include <sys/types.h>
41 #endif /* makedev */
42
43 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
44
45 #include "systime.h"
46
47 #include <fcntl.h>
48 #include <errno.h>
49 #include <sys/stat.h>
50 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
51 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
52
53 #include "charset.h"
54 #include "character.h"
55 #include "coding.h"
56 #include "frame.h"
57 #include "dispextern.h"
58 #include "fontset.h"
59 #include "termhooks.h"
60 #include "termopts.h"
61 #include "termchar.h"
62 #include "emacs-icon.h"
63 #include "disptab.h"
64 #include "buffer.h"
65 #include "window.h"
66 #include "keyboard.h"
67 #include "intervals.h"
68 #include "process.h"
69 #include "atimer.h"
70 #include "keymap.h"
71 #include "font.h"
72 #include "fontset.h"
73 #include "xsettings.h"
74 #include "xgselect.h"
75 #include "sysselect.h"
76
77 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
78 #include <X11/Shell.h>
79 #endif
80
81 #include <unistd.h>
82
83 #ifdef USE_GTK
84 #include "gtkutil.h"
85 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
86 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
87 #endif
88 #endif
89
90 #ifdef USE_LUCID
91 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
92 #endif
93
94 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
95 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
96 #define HACK_EDITRES
97 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
98 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
99
100 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
101
102 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
103 #if defined USE_MOTIF
104 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
105 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
106 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
107
108 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
109 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
110 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
111 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
112 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
113 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
114 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
115 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
116 #ifndef XtNpickTop
117 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
118 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
119 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
120 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
121
122 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
123
124 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
125 #include "widget.h"
126 #ifndef XtNinitialState
127 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
128 #endif
129 #endif
130
131 #include "bitmaps/gray.xbm"
132
133 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
134 #ifdef USE_XIM
135 int use_xim = 1;
136 #else
137 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
138 #endif
139
140 \f
141
142 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
143 start. */
144
145 static int any_help_event_p;
146
147 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
148 static Lisp_Object last_window;
149
150 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
151 use. */
152
153 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
154
155 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
156 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
157 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
158 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
159
160 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
161
162 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
163
164 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
165
166 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
167
168 static struct {
169 struct frame *f;
170 int eventtype;
171 } pending_event_wait;
172
173 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
174 /* The application context for Xt use. */
175 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
176 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
177
178 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
179
180 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
181 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
182
183 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
184 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
185 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
186
187 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
188
189 /* Mouse movement.
190
191 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
192 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
193 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
194 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
195
196 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
197
198 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
199 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
200 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
201 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
202 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
203 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
204 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
205 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
206 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
207 is off. */
208
209 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
210
211 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
212 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
213 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
214
215 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
216
217 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
218 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
219 an ordinary motion.
220
221 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
222 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
223 event. */
224
225 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
226
227 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
228 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
229 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
230 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
231 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
232 it's somewhat accurate. */
233
234 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
235
236 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
237
238 static Time last_user_time;
239
240 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
241 events. */
242
243 static int volatile input_signal_count;
244
245 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
246
247 static int x_noop_count;
248
249 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
250
251 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
252 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
253
254 #ifdef USE_GTK
255 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
256 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
257
258 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
259 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
260 #endif
261
262 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
263 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
264
265 enum xembed_info
266 {
267 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
268 };
269
270 enum xembed_message
271 {
272 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
273 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
274 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
275 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
276 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
277 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
278 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
279 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
280
281 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
282 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
283 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
284 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
285 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
286 };
287
288 /* Used in x_flush. */
289
290 static bool x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
291 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
292 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
293 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
294 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
295 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
296
297 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
298 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
299 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
300 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
301 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
302 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
303 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
304 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
305 static _Noreturn void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int);
306 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
307 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
308 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
309 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
310 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
311 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
312 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
313 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
314 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
315 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
316 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
317 enum text_cursor_kinds);
318
319 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
320 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
321 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
322 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
323 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
324 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
325 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
326 enum scroll_bar_part *,
327 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
328 Time *);
329 static int x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
330 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
331 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
332 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
333 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
334 int *, struct input_event *);
335 #ifdef USE_GTK
336 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
337 #endif
338 /* Don't declare this _Noreturn because we want no
339 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
340 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
341 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
342 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
343 static void x_initialize (void);
344
345
346 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
347
348 static void
349 x_flush (struct frame *f)
350 {
351 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
352 connection may be broken. */
353 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
354 return;
355
356 block_input ();
357 if (f == NULL)
358 {
359 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
360 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
361 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
362 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
363 }
364 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
365 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
366 unblock_input ();
367 }
368
369
370 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
371 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
372 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
373 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
374 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
375 performance. */
376
377 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
378
379 \f
380 /***********************************************************************
381 Debugging
382 ***********************************************************************/
383
384 #if 0
385
386 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
387 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
388
389 struct record
390 {
391 char *locus;
392 int type;
393 };
394
395 struct record event_record[100];
396
397 int event_record_index;
398
399 void
400 record_event (char *locus, int type)
401 {
402 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
403 event_record_index = 0;
404
405 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
406 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
407 event_record_index++;
408 }
409
410 #endif /* 0 */
411
412
413 \f
414 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
415
416 struct x_display_info *
417 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
418 {
419 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
420
421 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
422 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
423 return dpyinfo;
424
425 return 0;
426 }
427
428 static Window
429 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
430 {
431 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
432 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
433 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
434
435 while (wi != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
436 {
437 Window root;
438 Window *children;
439 unsigned int nchildren;
440
441 win = wi;
442 XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren);
443 XFree (children);
444 }
445
446 return win;
447 }
448
449 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
450
451 void
452 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
453 {
454 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
455 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
456 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
457 double alpha = 1.0;
458 double alpha_min = 1.0;
459 unsigned long opac;
460 Window parent;
461
462 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
463 alpha = f->alpha[0];
464 else
465 alpha = f->alpha[1];
466
467 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
468 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
469 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
470 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
471
472 if (alpha < 0.0)
473 return;
474 else if (alpha > 1.0)
475 alpha = 1.0;
476 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
477 alpha = alpha_min;
478
479 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
480
481 x_catch_errors (dpy);
482
483 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
484 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
485 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
486 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
487
488 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
489 if (parent != None)
490 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
491 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
492 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
493
494 /* return unless necessary */
495 {
496 unsigned char *data;
497 Atom actual;
498 int rc, format;
499 unsigned long n, left;
500
501 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
502 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
503 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
504 &data);
505
506 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
507 {
508 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
509 XFree (data);
510 if (value == opac)
511 {
512 x_uncatch_errors ();
513 return;
514 }
515 }
516 }
517
518 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
519 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
520 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
521 x_uncatch_errors ();
522 }
523
524 int
525 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
526 {
527 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
528 }
529
530 int
531 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
532 {
533 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
534 }
535
536 \f
537 /***********************************************************************
538 Starting and ending an update
539 ***********************************************************************/
540
541 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
542 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
543 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
544 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
545 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
546
547 static void
548 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
549 {
550 /* Nothing to do. */
551 }
552
553
554 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
555 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
556 position of W. */
557
558 static void
559 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
560 {
561 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
562 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
563
564 updated_window = w;
565 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
566
567 block_input ();
568
569 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
570 {
571 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
572 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
573
574 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
575 highlighting. */
576 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
577 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
578 }
579
580 unblock_input ();
581 }
582
583
584 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
585
586 static void
587 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
588 {
589 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
590 struct face *face;
591
592 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
593 if (face)
594 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
595 face->foreground);
596
597 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
598 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
599 }
600
601 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
602
603 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
604 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
605
606 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
607 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
608 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
609
610 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
611 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
612 here. */
613
614 static void
615 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
616 {
617 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
618
619 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
620 {
621 block_input ();
622
623 if (cursor_on_p)
624 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
625 output_cursor.vpos,
626 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
627
628 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
629 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
630
631 unblock_input ();
632 }
633
634 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
635 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
636 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
637 {
638 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
639 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
640 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
641 }
642
643 updated_window = NULL;
644 }
645
646
647 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
648 update_end. */
649
650 static void
651 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
652 {
653 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
654 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
655
656 #ifndef XFlush
657 block_input ();
658 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
659 unblock_input ();
660 #endif
661 }
662
663
664 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
665 complete update has been performed. The global variable
666 updated_window is not available here. */
667
668 static void
669 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
670 {
671 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
672 FRAME_MOUSE_UPDATE (f);
673 }
674
675
676 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
677 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
678 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
679 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
680 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
681 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
682
683 static void
684 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
685 {
686 struct window *w = updated_window;
687 struct frame *f;
688 int width, height;
689
690 eassert (w);
691
692 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
693 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
694
695 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
696 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
697 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
698 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
699 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
700 overhead is very small. */
701 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
702 && desired_row->full_width_p
703 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
704 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
705 width != 0)
706 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
707 height > 0))
708 {
709 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
710
711 block_input ();
712 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
713 0, y, width, height, False);
714 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
715 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
716 y, width, height, False);
717 unblock_input ();
718 }
719 }
720
721 static void
722 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
723 {
724 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
725 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
726 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
727 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
728 struct face *face = p->face;
729
730 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
731 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
732
733 if (!p->overlay_p)
734 {
735 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
736
737 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
738 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
739 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
740 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
741 if (face->stipple)
742 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
743 else
744 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
745
746 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
747 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
748 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
749 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
750 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
751 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
752 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
753 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
754 {
755 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
756
757 if (sb_width > 0)
758 {
759 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
760 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
761 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
762
763 if (bx < 0)
764 {
765 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
766 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == p->x)
767 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
768 else if (p->x + p->wd == bar_area_x)
769 bx = bar_area_x;
770 if (bx >= 0)
771 {
772 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
773
774 nx = bar_area_width - sb_width;
775 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
776 row->y));
777 ny = row->visible_height;
778 }
779 }
780 else
781 {
782 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == bx)
783 {
784 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
785 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
786 }
787 else if (bx + nx == bar_area_x)
788 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
789 }
790 }
791 }
792 #endif
793 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
794 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
795
796 if (!face->stipple)
797 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
798 }
799
800 if (p->which)
801 {
802 char *bits;
803 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
804 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
805 XGCValues gcv;
806
807 if (p->wd > 8)
808 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
809 else
810 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
811
812 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
813 by the server. */
814 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
815 (p->cursor_p
816 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
817 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
818 : face->foreground),
819 face->background, depth);
820
821 if (p->overlay_p)
822 {
823 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
824 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
825 bits, p->wd, p->h,
826 1, 0, 1);
827 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
828 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
829 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
830 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
831 }
832
833 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
834 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
835 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
836
837 if (p->overlay_p)
838 {
839 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
840 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
841 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
842 }
843 }
844
845 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
846 }
847
848 \f
849
850 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
851 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
852 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
853 rarely happens). */
854
855 static void
856 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
857 {
858 }
859
860 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
861 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
862
863 static void
864 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
865 {
866 }
867
868 \f
869 /***********************************************************************
870 Glyph display
871 ***********************************************************************/
872
873
874
875 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
876 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
877 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
878 int);
879 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
880 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
881 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
882 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
883 static _Noreturn void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int);
884 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
885 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
886 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
887 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
888 static bool x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
889 unsigned long *, double, int);
890 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
891 double, int, unsigned long);
892 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
893 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
894 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
895 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
896 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
897 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
898 int, int, int);
899 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
900 int, int, int, int, int, int,
901 XRectangle *);
902 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
903 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
904 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
905
906 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
907 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
908 #endif
909
910
911 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
912 face. */
913
914 static void
915 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
916 {
917 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
918 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
919 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
920 && !s->cmp)
921 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
922 else
923 {
924 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
925 XGCValues xgcv;
926 unsigned long mask;
927
928 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
929 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
930
931 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
932 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
933 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
934 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
935 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
936 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
937 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
938
939 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
940 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
941 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
942 {
943 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
944 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
945 }
946
947 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
948 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
949 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
950
951 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
952 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
953 mask, &xgcv);
954 else
955 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
956 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
957
958 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
959 }
960 }
961
962
963 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
964
965 static void
966 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
967 {
968 int face_id;
969 struct face *face;
970
971 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
972 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
973 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
974 if (face == NULL)
975 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
976
977 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
978 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
979 else
980 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
981 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
982 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
983
984 if (s->font == s->face->font)
985 s->gc = s->face->gc;
986 else
987 {
988 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
989 except for FONT. */
990 XGCValues xgcv;
991 unsigned long mask;
992
993 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
994 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
995 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
996 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
997
998 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
999 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1000 mask, &xgcv);
1001 else
1002 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1003 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1004
1005 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1006
1007 }
1008 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1009 }
1010
1011
1012 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1013 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1014 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1015
1016 static void
1017 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1018 {
1019 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1020 }
1021
1022
1023 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1024 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1025 pattern. */
1026
1027 static void
1028 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1029 {
1030 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1031
1032 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1033 {
1034 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1035 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1036 }
1037 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1038 {
1039 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1040 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1041 }
1042 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1043 {
1044 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1045 s->stippled_p = 0;
1046 }
1047 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1048 {
1049 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1050 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1051 }
1052 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1053 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1054 {
1055 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1056 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1057 }
1058 else
1059 {
1060 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1061 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1062 }
1063
1064 /* GC must have been set. */
1065 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1066 }
1067
1068
1069 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1070 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1071
1072 static void
1073 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1074 {
1075 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1076 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1077
1078 if (n > 0)
1079 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1080 s->num_clips = n;
1081 }
1082
1083
1084 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1085 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1086 the area of SRC. */
1087
1088 static void
1089 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1090 {
1091 XRectangle r;
1092
1093 r.x = src->x;
1094 r.width = src->width;
1095 r.y = src->y;
1096 r.height = src->height;
1097 dst->clip[0] = r;
1098 dst->num_clips = 1;
1099 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1100 }
1101
1102
1103 /* RIF:
1104 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1105
1106 static void
1107 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1108 {
1109 if (s->cmp == NULL
1110 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1111 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1112 {
1113 struct font_metrics metrics;
1114
1115 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1116 {
1117 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1118 struct font *font = s->font;
1119 int i;
1120
1121 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1122 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1123 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1124 }
1125 else
1126 {
1127 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1128
1129 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1130 }
1131 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1132 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1133 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1134 }
1135 else if (s->cmp)
1136 {
1137 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1138 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1139 }
1140 }
1141
1142
1143 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1144
1145 static void
1146 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1147 {
1148 XGCValues xgcv;
1149 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1150 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1151 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1152 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1153 }
1154
1155
1156 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1157 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1158 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1159 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1160 contains the first component of a composition. */
1161
1162 static void
1163 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1164 {
1165 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1166 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1167 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1168 {
1169 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1170
1171 if (s->stippled_p)
1172 {
1173 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1174 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1175 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1176 s->y + box_line_width,
1177 s->background_width,
1178 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1179 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1180 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1181 }
1182 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1183 || s->font_not_found_p
1184 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1185 || force_p)
1186 {
1187 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1188 s->background_width,
1189 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1190 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1191 }
1192 }
1193 }
1194
1195
1196 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1197
1198 static void
1199 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1200 {
1201 int i, x;
1202
1203 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1204 of S to the right of that box line. */
1205 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1206 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1207 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1208 else
1209 x = s->x;
1210
1211 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1212 loaded. */
1213 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1214 {
1215 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1216 {
1217 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1218 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1219 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1220 s->height - 1);
1221 x += g->pixel_width;
1222 }
1223 }
1224 else
1225 {
1226 struct font *font = s->font;
1227 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1228 int y;
1229
1230 if (font->vertical_centering)
1231 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1232
1233 y = s->ybase - boff;
1234 if (s->for_overlaps
1235 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1236 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1237 else
1238 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1239 if (s->face->overstrike)
1240 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1241 }
1242 }
1243
1244 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1245
1246 static void
1247 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1248 {
1249 int i, j, x;
1250 struct font *font = s->font;
1251
1252 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1253 of S to the right of that box line. */
1254 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1255 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1256 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1257 else
1258 x = s->x;
1259
1260 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1261 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1262 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1263 this composition. */
1264
1265 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1266 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1267 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1268 {
1269 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1270 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1271 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1272 }
1273 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1274 {
1275 int y = s->ybase;
1276
1277 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1278 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1279 space on the left or right. */
1280 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1281 {
1282 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1283 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1284
1285 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1286 if (s->face->overstrike)
1287 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1288 }
1289 }
1290 else
1291 {
1292 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1293 Lisp_Object glyph;
1294 int y = s->ybase;
1295 int width = 0;
1296
1297 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1298 {
1299 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1300 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1301 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1302 else
1303 {
1304 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1305
1306 if (j < i)
1307 {
1308 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1309 if (s->face->overstrike)
1310 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1311 x += width;
1312 }
1313 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1314 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1315 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1316 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1317 if (s->face->overstrike)
1318 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1319 x += wadjust;
1320 j = i + 1;
1321 width = 0;
1322 }
1323 }
1324 if (j < i)
1325 {
1326 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1327 if (s->face->overstrike)
1328 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1329 }
1330 }
1331 }
1332
1333
1334 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1335
1336 static void
1337 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1338 {
1339 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1340 XChar2b char2b[8];
1341 int x, i, j;
1342
1343 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1344 of S to the right of that box line. */
1345 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1346 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1347 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1348 else
1349 x = s->x;
1350
1351 s->char2b = char2b;
1352
1353 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1354 {
1355 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1356 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1357
1358 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1359 {
1360 if (len > 0
1361 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1362 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1363 >= 1))
1364 {
1365 Lisp_Object acronym
1366 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1367 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1368 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1369 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1370 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1371 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1372 }
1373 }
1374 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1375 {
1376 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1377 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1378 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1379 str = buf;
1380 }
1381
1382 if (str)
1383 {
1384 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1385 unsigned code;
1386
1387 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1388 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1389 {
1390 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1391 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1392 }
1393 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1394 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1395 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1396 0);
1397 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1398 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1399 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1400 0);
1401 }
1402 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1403 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1404 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1405 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1406 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1407 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1408 }
1409 }
1410
1411 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1412
1413 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1414 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1415 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1416 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1417
1418 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1419
1420 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1421 cannot be determined. */
1422
1423 static struct frame *
1424 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1425 {
1426 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1427 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
1428 struct frame *f;
1429
1430 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1431
1432 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1433 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1434 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1435 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1436 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1437 widget = XtParent (widget);
1438
1439 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1440 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1441 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
1442 {
1443 f = XFRAME (frame);
1444 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
1445 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1446 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo
1447 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1448 return f;
1449 }
1450 emacs_abort ();
1451 }
1452
1453 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1454 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1455 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1456 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1457 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1458 Value is true if successful. */
1459
1460 bool
1461 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1462 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1463 {
1464 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1465 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1466 }
1467
1468 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
1469
1470
1471 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1472 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1473
1474 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1475 {
1476 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1477 sizeof (Screen *)},
1478 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1479 sizeof (Colormap)}
1480 };
1481
1482
1483 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1484 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1485
1486 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1487
1488
1489 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1490
1491 DPY is the display we are working on.
1492
1493 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1494 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1495 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1496 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1497
1498 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1499 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1500
1501 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1502 we allocated the color or not.
1503
1504 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1505
1506 static Boolean
1507 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1508 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1509 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1510 {
1511 Screen *screen;
1512 Colormap cmap;
1513 Pixel pixel;
1514 String color_name;
1515 XColor color;
1516
1517 if (*nargs != 2)
1518 {
1519 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1520 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1521 "XtToolkitError",
1522 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1523 return False;
1524 }
1525
1526 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1527 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1528 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1529
1530 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1531 {
1532 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1533 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1534 }
1535 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1536 {
1537 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1538 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1539 }
1540 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1541 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1542 {
1543 pixel = color.pixel;
1544 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1545 }
1546 else
1547 {
1548 String params[1];
1549 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1550
1551 params[0] = color_name;
1552 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1553 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1554 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1555 params, &nparams);
1556 return False;
1557 }
1558
1559 if (to->addr != NULL)
1560 {
1561 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1562 {
1563 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1564 return False;
1565 }
1566
1567 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1568 }
1569 else
1570 {
1571 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1572 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1573 }
1574
1575 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1576 return True;
1577 }
1578
1579
1580 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1581 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1582 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1583
1584 APP is the application context in which we work.
1585
1586 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1587 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1588 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1589
1590 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1591
1592 static void
1593 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1594 Cardinal *nargs)
1595 {
1596 if (*nargs != 2)
1597 {
1598 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1599 "XtToolkitError",
1600 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1601 NULL, NULL);
1602 }
1603 else if (closure != NULL)
1604 {
1605 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1606 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1607 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1608 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1609 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1610 }
1611 }
1612
1613
1614 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1615
1616
1617 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1618 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1619 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1620 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1621
1622 static const XColor *
1623 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1624 {
1625 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1626
1627 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1628 {
1629 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1630 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1631 int i;
1632
1633 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
1634 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1635 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
1636
1637 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
1638 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1639
1640 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1641 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
1642 }
1643
1644 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1645 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1646 }
1647
1648
1649 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1650 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1651
1652 void
1653 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1654 {
1655 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1656
1657 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1658 {
1659 int i;
1660 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1661 {
1662 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1663 eassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1664 eassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1665 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1666 }
1667 }
1668 else
1669 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1670 }
1671
1672
1673 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1674 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1675
1676 void
1677 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1678 {
1679 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1680 }
1681
1682
1683 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1684 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1685 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1686 allocated. */
1687
1688 static bool
1689 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1690 {
1691 bool rc;
1692
1693 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1694 if (rc == 0)
1695 {
1696 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1697 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1698 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1699 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1700 int nearest, i;
1701 int max_color_delta = 255;
1702 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
1703 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
1704 int ncells;
1705 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1706
1707 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1708 {
1709 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1710 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1711 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1712 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1713
1714 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1715 {
1716 nearest = i;
1717 nearest_delta = delta;
1718 }
1719 }
1720
1721 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1722 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1723 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1724 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1725 }
1726 else
1727 {
1728 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1729 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1730 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1731 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1732 XColor *cached_color;
1733
1734 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1735 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1736 (cached_color->red != color->red
1737 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1738 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1739 {
1740 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1741 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1742 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1743 }
1744 }
1745
1746 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1747 if (rc)
1748 register_color (color->pixel);
1749 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1750
1751 return rc;
1752 }
1753
1754
1755 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1756 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1757 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1758 allocated. */
1759
1760 bool
1761 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1762 {
1763 gamma_correct (f, color);
1764 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1765 }
1766
1767
1768 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1769 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1770 get color reference counts right. */
1771
1772 unsigned long
1773 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1774 {
1775 XColor color;
1776
1777 color.pixel = pixel;
1778 block_input ();
1779 x_query_color (f, &color);
1780 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1781 unblock_input ();
1782 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1783 register_color (pixel);
1784 #endif
1785 return color.pixel;
1786 }
1787
1788
1789 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1790 boosted.
1791
1792 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1793 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1794 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1795 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1796 use an additional additive factor.
1797
1798 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1799 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1800 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1801
1802
1803 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1804 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1805 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1806 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1807 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1808 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1809
1810 static bool
1811 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1812 {
1813 XColor color, new;
1814 long bright;
1815 bool success_p;
1816
1817 /* Get RGB color values. */
1818 color.pixel = *pixel;
1819 x_query_color (f, &color);
1820
1821 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1822 eassert (factor >= 0);
1823 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1824 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1825 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1826
1827 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1828 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1829
1830 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1831 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1832 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1833 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1834 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1835 {
1836 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1837 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1838 /* The additive adjustment. */
1839 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1840
1841 if (factor < 1)
1842 {
1843 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1844 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1845 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1846 }
1847 else
1848 {
1849 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1850 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1851 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1852 }
1853 }
1854
1855 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1856 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1857 if (success_p)
1858 {
1859 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1860 {
1861 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1862 delta to the RGB values. */
1863 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1864
1865 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1866 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1867 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1868 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1869 }
1870 else
1871 success_p = 1;
1872 *pixel = new.pixel;
1873 }
1874
1875 return success_p;
1876 }
1877
1878
1879 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1880 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1881 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1882 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1883 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1884 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1885
1886 static void
1887 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1888 {
1889 XGCValues xgcv;
1890 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1891 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1892 unsigned long pixel;
1893 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1894 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1895 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1896 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1897
1898 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1899 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1900
1901 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1902 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1903 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1904 if (relief->gc
1905 && relief->allocated_p)
1906 {
1907 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1908 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1909 }
1910
1911 /* Allocate new color. */
1912 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1913 pixel = background;
1914 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1915 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1916 {
1917 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1918 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1919 }
1920
1921 if (relief->gc == 0)
1922 {
1923 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1924 mask |= GCStipple;
1925 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1926 }
1927 else
1928 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1929 }
1930
1931
1932 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1933
1934 static void
1935 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1936 {
1937 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1938 unsigned long color;
1939
1940 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1941 color = s->face->box_color;
1942 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1943 && s->img->pixmap
1944 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1945 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1946 else
1947 {
1948 XGCValues xgcv;
1949
1950 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1951 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1952 color = xgcv.background;
1953 }
1954
1955 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1956 || color != di->relief_background)
1957 {
1958 di->relief_background = color;
1959 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1960 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1961 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1962 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1963 }
1964 }
1965
1966
1967 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1968 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1969 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1970 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1971 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1972 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1973 when drawing. */
1974
1975 static void
1976 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
1977 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
1978 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
1979 XRectangle *clip_rect)
1980 {
1981 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1982 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1983 int i;
1984 GC gc;
1985
1986 if (raised_p)
1987 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1988 else
1989 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1990 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1991
1992 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
1993 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
1994 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
1995 corner pixels. */
1996
1997 /* Top. */
1998 if (top_p)
1999 {
2000 if (width == 1)
2001 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2002 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2003 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2004
2005 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2006 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2007 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2008 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2009 }
2010
2011 /* Left. */
2012 if (left_p)
2013 {
2014 if (width == 1)
2015 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2016
2017 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2018 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2019
2020 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2021 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2022 left_x + i, top_y + (i + 1) * top_p,
2023 left_x + i, bottom_y + 1 - (i + 1) * bot_p);
2024 }
2025
2026 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2027 if (raised_p)
2028 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2029 else
2030 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2031 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2032
2033 if (width > 1)
2034 {
2035 /* Outermost top line. */
2036 if (top_p)
2037 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2038 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2039 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2040
2041 /* Outermost left line. */
2042 if (left_p)
2043 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2044 }
2045
2046 /* Bottom. */
2047 if (bot_p)
2048 {
2049 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2050 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2051 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2052 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2053 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2054 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2055 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2056 }
2057
2058 /* Right. */
2059 if (right_p)
2060 {
2061 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2062 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2063 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2064 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2065 right_x - i, top_y + (i + 1) * top_p,
2066 right_x - i, bottom_y + 1 - (i + 1) * bot_p);
2067 }
2068
2069 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2070 }
2071
2072
2073 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2074 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2075 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2076 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2077 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2078 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2079
2080 static void
2081 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2082 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2083 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2084 {
2085 XGCValues xgcv;
2086
2087 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2088 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2089 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2090
2091 /* Top. */
2092 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2093 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2094
2095 /* Left. */
2096 if (left_p)
2097 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2098 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2099
2100 /* Bottom. */
2101 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2102 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2103
2104 /* Right. */
2105 if (right_p)
2106 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2107 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2108
2109 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2110 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2111 }
2112
2113
2114 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2115
2116 static void
2117 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2118 {
2119 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2120 int left_p, right_p;
2121 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2122 XRectangle clip_rect;
2123
2124 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2125 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2126 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2127
2128 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2129 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2130 ? s->first_glyph
2131 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2132
2133 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2134 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2135 left_x = s->x;
2136 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2137 ? last_x - 1
2138 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2139 top_y = s->y;
2140 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2141
2142 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2143 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2144 && (s->prev == NULL
2145 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2146 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2147 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2148 && (s->next == NULL
2149 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2150
2151 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2152
2153 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2154 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2155 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2156 else
2157 {
2158 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2159 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2160 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2161 }
2162 }
2163
2164
2165 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2166
2167 static void
2168 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2169 {
2170 int x = s->x;
2171 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2172
2173 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2174 right of that line. */
2175 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2176 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2177 && s->slice.x == 0)
2178 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2179
2180 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2181 by that margin. */
2182 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2183 x += s->img->hmargin;
2184 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2185 y += s->img->vmargin;
2186
2187 if (s->img->pixmap)
2188 {
2189 if (s->img->mask)
2190 {
2191 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2192 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2193 trust on the shape extension to be available
2194 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2195 manually. */
2196 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2197 | GCFunction);
2198 XGCValues xgcv;
2199 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2200
2201 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2202 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2203 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2204 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2205 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2206
2207 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2208 image_rect.x = x;
2209 image_rect.y = y;
2210 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2211 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2212 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2213 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2214 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2215 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2216 }
2217 else
2218 {
2219 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2220
2221 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2222 image_rect.x = x;
2223 image_rect.y = y;
2224 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2225 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2226 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2227 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2228 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2229 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2230
2231 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2232 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2233 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2234 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2235 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2236 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2237 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2238 {
2239 int relief = s->img->relief;
2240 if (relief < 0) relief = -relief;
2241 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2242 x - relief, y - relief,
2243 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2244 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2245 }
2246 }
2247 }
2248 else
2249 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2250 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2251 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2252 }
2253
2254
2255 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2256
2257 static void
2258 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2259 {
2260 int x1, y1, thick, raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p;
2261 int extra_x, extra_y;
2262 XRectangle r;
2263 int x = s->x;
2264 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2265
2266 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2267 right of that line. */
2268 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2269 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2270 && s->slice.x == 0)
2271 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2272
2273 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2274 by that margin. */
2275 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2276 x += s->img->hmargin;
2277 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2278 y += s->img->vmargin;
2279
2280 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2281 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2282 {
2283 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2284 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2285 }
2286 else
2287 {
2288 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2289 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2290 }
2291
2292 extra_x = extra_y = 0;
2293 if (s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID)
2294 {
2295 if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin)
2296 && INTEGERP (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2297 && INTEGERP (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)))
2298 {
2299 extra_x = XINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2300 extra_y = XINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2301 }
2302 else if (INTEGERP (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2303 extra_x = extra_y = XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
2304 }
2305
2306 x1 = x + s->slice.width - 1;
2307 y1 = y + s->slice.height - 1;
2308 top_p = bot_p = left_p = right_p = 0;
2309
2310 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2311 x -= thick, left_p = 1;
2312 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2313 y -= thick, top_p = 1;
2314 if (s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width)
2315 x1 += thick, right_p = 1;
2316 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height)
2317 y1 += thick, bot_p = 1;
2318
2319 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2320 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2321 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x, y, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2322 top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, &r);
2323 }
2324
2325
2326 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2327
2328 static void
2329 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2330 {
2331 int x = 0;
2332 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2333
2334 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2335 right of that line. */
2336 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2337 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2338 && s->slice.x == 0)
2339 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2340
2341 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2342 by that margin. */
2343 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2344 x += s->img->hmargin;
2345 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2346 y += s->img->vmargin;
2347
2348 if (s->img->pixmap)
2349 {
2350 if (s->img->mask)
2351 {
2352 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2353 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2354 trust on the shape extension to be available
2355 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2356 manually. */
2357 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2358 | GCFunction);
2359 XGCValues xgcv;
2360
2361 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2362 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2363 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2364 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2365 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2366
2367 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2368 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2369 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2370 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2371 }
2372 else
2373 {
2374 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2375 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2376 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2377
2378 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2379 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2380 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2381 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2382 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2383 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2384 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2385 {
2386 int r = s->img->relief;
2387 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2388 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2389 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2390 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2391 }
2392 }
2393 }
2394 else
2395 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2396 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2397 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2398 }
2399
2400
2401 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2402 give the rectangle to draw. */
2403
2404 static void
2405 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2406 {
2407 if (s->stippled_p)
2408 {
2409 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2410 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2411 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2412 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2413 }
2414 else
2415 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2416 }
2417
2418
2419 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2420
2421 s->y
2422 s->x +-------------------------
2423 | s->face->box
2424 |
2425 | +-------------------------
2426 | | s->img->margin
2427 | |
2428 | | +-------------------
2429 | | | the image
2430
2431 */
2432
2433 static void
2434 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2435 {
2436 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2437 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2438 int height;
2439 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2440
2441 height = s->height;
2442 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2443 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2444 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2445 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2446
2447 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2448 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2449 flickering. */
2450 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2451 if (height > s->slice.height
2452 || s->img->hmargin
2453 || s->img->vmargin
2454 || s->img->mask
2455 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2456 || s->width != s->background_width)
2457 {
2458 if (s->img->mask)
2459 {
2460 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2461 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2462 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2463 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2464 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2465
2466 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2467 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2468 s->background_width,
2469 s->height, depth);
2470
2471 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2472 pixmap. */
2473 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2474
2475 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2476 if (s->stippled_p)
2477 {
2478 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2479 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2480 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2481 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2482 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2483 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2484 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2485 }
2486 else
2487 {
2488 XGCValues xgcv;
2489 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2490 &xgcv);
2491 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2492 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2493 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2494 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2495 }
2496 }
2497 else
2498 {
2499 int x = s->x;
2500 int y = s->y;
2501
2502 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2503 && s->slice.x == 0)
2504 x += box_line_hwidth;
2505
2506 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2507 y += box_line_vwidth;
2508
2509 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2510 }
2511
2512 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2513 }
2514
2515 /* Draw the foreground. */
2516 if (pixmap != None)
2517 {
2518 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2519 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2520 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2521 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2522 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2523 }
2524 else
2525 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2526
2527 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2528 if (s->img->relief
2529 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2530 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2531 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2532 }
2533
2534
2535 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2536
2537 static void
2538 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2539 {
2540 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2541
2542 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2543 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2544 {
2545 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2546 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2547 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2548 int x = s->x;
2549
2550 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2551 {
2552 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2553
2554 if (x < left_x)
2555 {
2556 background_width -= left_x - x;
2557 x = left_x;
2558 }
2559 }
2560 else
2561 {
2562 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2563 stretch glyph. */
2564 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2565
2566 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2567 background_width -= x - right_x;
2568 x += background_width;
2569 }
2570 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2571 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2572 x -= width;
2573
2574 /* Draw cursor. */
2575 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2576
2577 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2578 if (width < background_width)
2579 {
2580 int y = s->y;
2581 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2582 XRectangle r;
2583 GC gc;
2584
2585 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2586 x += width;
2587 else
2588 x = s->x;
2589 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2590 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2591 {
2592 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2593 gc = s->gc;
2594 }
2595 else
2596 gc = s->face->gc;
2597
2598 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2599 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2600
2601 if (s->face->stipple)
2602 {
2603 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2604 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2605 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2606 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2607 }
2608 else
2609 {
2610 XGCValues xgcv;
2611 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2612 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2613 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2614 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2615 }
2616 }
2617 }
2618 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2619 {
2620 int background_width = s->background_width;
2621 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2622
2623 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2624 except for header line and mode line. */
2625 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2626 {
2627 background_width -= left_x - x;
2628 x = left_x;
2629 }
2630 if (background_width > 0)
2631 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2632 }
2633
2634 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2635 }
2636
2637 /*
2638 Draw a wavy line under S. The wave fills wave_height pixels from y0.
2639
2640 x0 wave_length = 2
2641 --
2642 y0 * * * * *
2643 |* * * * * * * * *
2644 wave_height = 3 | * * * *
2645
2646 */
2647
2648 static void
2649 x_draw_underwave (struct glyph_string *s)
2650 {
2651 int wave_height = 2, wave_length = 3;
2652 int dx, dy, x0, y0, width, x1, y1, x2, y2, odd, xmax;
2653 XRectangle wave_clip, string_clip, final_clip;
2654
2655 dx = wave_length;
2656 dy = wave_height - 1;
2657 x0 = s->x;
2658 y0 = s->ybase + 1;
2659 width = s->width;
2660 xmax = x0 + width;
2661
2662 /* Find and set clipping rectangle */
2663
2664 wave_clip = (XRectangle){ x0, y0, width, wave_height };
2665 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &string_clip);
2666
2667 if (!x_intersect_rectangles (&wave_clip, &string_clip, &final_clip))
2668 return;
2669
2670 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &final_clip, 1, Unsorted);
2671
2672 /* Draw the waves */
2673
2674 x1 = x0 - (x0 % dx);
2675 x2 = x1 + dx;
2676 odd = (x1/dx) % 2;
2677 y1 = y2 = y0;
2678
2679 if (odd)
2680 y1 += dy;
2681 else
2682 y2 += dy;
2683
2684 if (INT_MAX - dx < xmax)
2685 emacs_abort ();
2686
2687 while (x1 <= xmax)
2688 {
2689 XDrawLine (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x1, y1, x2, y2);
2690 x1 = x2, y1 = y2;
2691 x2 += dx, y2 = y0 + odd*dy;
2692 odd = !odd;
2693 }
2694
2695 /* Restore previous clipping rectangle(s) */
2696 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, s->clip, s->num_clips, Unsorted);
2697 }
2698
2699
2700 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2701
2702 static void
2703 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2704 {
2705 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2706
2707 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2708 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2709 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2710 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2711 {
2712 int width;
2713 struct glyph_string *next;
2714
2715 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2716 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2717 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2718 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2719 {
2720 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2721 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2722 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2723 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2724 else
2725 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2726 next->num_clips = 0;
2727 }
2728 }
2729
2730 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2731 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2732
2733 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2734 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2735 if (!s->for_overlaps
2736 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2737 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2738 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2739
2740 {
2741 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2742 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2743 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2744 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2745 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2746 }
2747 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2748 && !s->clip_tail
2749 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2750 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2751 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2752 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2753 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2754 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2755 else
2756 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2757
2758 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2759 {
2760 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2761 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2762 break;
2763
2764 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2765 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2766 break;
2767
2768 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2769 if (s->for_overlaps)
2770 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2771 else
2772 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2773 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2774 break;
2775
2776 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2777 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2778 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2779 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2780 else
2781 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2782 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2783 break;
2784
2785 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2786 if (s->for_overlaps)
2787 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2788 else
2789 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2790 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2791 break;
2792
2793 default:
2794 emacs_abort ();
2795 }
2796
2797 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2798 {
2799 /* Draw underline. */
2800 if (s->face->underline_p)
2801 {
2802 if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_WAVE)
2803 {
2804 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2805 x_draw_underwave (s);
2806 else
2807 {
2808 XGCValues xgcv;
2809 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2810 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2811 x_draw_underwave (s);
2812 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2813 }
2814 }
2815 else if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2816 {
2817 unsigned long thickness, position;
2818 int y;
2819
2820 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2821 {
2822 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2823 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2824 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2825 }
2826 else
2827 {
2828 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2829 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2830 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2831 else
2832 thickness = 1;
2833 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2834 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2835 else
2836 {
2837 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2838 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2839 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2840 specs, and its default is
2841
2842 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2843 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2844
2845 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2846 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2847 position = s->font->underline_position;
2848 else if (s->font)
2849 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2850 else
2851 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2852 }
2853 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2854 }
2855 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2856 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2857 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2858 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2859 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2860 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2861 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2862 s->underline_position = position;
2863 y = s->ybase + position;
2864 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2865 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2866 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2867 else
2868 {
2869 XGCValues xgcv;
2870 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2871 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2872 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2873 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2874 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2875 }
2876 }
2877 }
2878 /* Draw overline. */
2879 if (s->face->overline_p)
2880 {
2881 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2882
2883 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2884 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2885 s->width, h);
2886 else
2887 {
2888 XGCValues xgcv;
2889 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2890 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2891 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2892 s->width, h);
2893 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2894 }
2895 }
2896
2897 /* Draw strike-through. */
2898 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2899 {
2900 unsigned long h = 1;
2901 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2902
2903 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2904 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2905 s->width, h);
2906 else
2907 {
2908 XGCValues xgcv;
2909 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2910 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2911 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2912 s->width, h);
2913 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2914 }
2915 }
2916
2917 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2918 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2919 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2920
2921 if (s->prev)
2922 {
2923 struct glyph_string *prev;
2924
2925 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2926 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2927 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2928 {
2929 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2930 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2931 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2932
2933 prev->hl = s->hl;
2934 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2935 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2936 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2937 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2938 else
2939 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2940 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2941 prev->hl = save;
2942 prev->num_clips = 0;
2943 }
2944 }
2945
2946 if (s->next)
2947 {
2948 struct glyph_string *next;
2949
2950 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2951 if (next->hl != s->hl
2952 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2953 {
2954 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2955 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2956 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2957
2958 next->hl = s->hl;
2959 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2960 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2961 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2962 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2963 else
2964 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2965 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2966 next->hl = save;
2967 next->num_clips = 0;
2968 next->clip_head = s->next;
2969 }
2970 }
2971 }
2972
2973 /* Reset clipping. */
2974 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2975 s->num_clips = 0;
2976 }
2977
2978 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2979
2980 static void
2981 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2982 {
2983 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2984 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2985 x, y, width, height,
2986 x + shift_by, y);
2987 }
2988
2989 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2990 for X frames. */
2991
2992 static void
2993 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2994 {
2995 emacs_abort ();
2996 }
2997
2998
2999 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
3000 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
3001
3002 void
3003 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
3004 {
3005 eassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
3006 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
3007 }
3008
3009
3010 /* Clear an entire frame. */
3011
3012 static void
3013 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
3014 {
3015 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
3016 longer visible. */
3017 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
3018 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
3019 output_cursor.x = -1;
3020
3021 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
3022 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
3023 block_input ();
3024
3025 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
3026
3027 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
3028 something like that, then they should be notified. */
3029 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
3030
3031 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3032 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
3033 redisplay, do it here. */
3034 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
3035 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3036 #endif
3037
3038 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3039
3040 unblock_input ();
3041 }
3042
3043
3044 \f
3045 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
3046
3047 static void
3048 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3049 {
3050 block_input ();
3051
3052 {
3053 #ifdef USE_GTK
3054 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3055 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3056 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3057 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3058 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3059 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3060 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3061 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3062 do { \
3063 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3064 cairo_fill (cr); \
3065 } \
3066 while (0)
3067 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3068 GdkGCValues vals;
3069 GdkGC *gc;
3070 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3071 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3072 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3073 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3074 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3075 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3076 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3077 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3078 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3079 GC gc;
3080
3081 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3082 pixels into background pixels. */
3083 {
3084 XGCValues values;
3085
3086 values.function = GXxor;
3087 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3088 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3089
3090 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3091 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3092 }
3093 #endif
3094 {
3095 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3096 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3097 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3098 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3099 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3100 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3101 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3102
3103 int width;
3104
3105 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3106 edge it is next to. */
3107 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3108 {
3109 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3110 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3111 break;
3112
3113 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3114 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3115 break;
3116
3117 default:
3118 break;
3119 }
3120
3121 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3122
3123 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3124 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3125 {
3126 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3127 flash_left,
3128 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3129 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3130 width, flash_height);
3131 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3132 flash_left,
3133 (height - flash_height
3134 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3135 width, flash_height);
3136
3137 }
3138 else
3139 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3140 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3141 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3142 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3143
3144 x_flush (f);
3145
3146 {
3147 EMACS_TIME delay = make_emacs_time (0, 150 * 1000 * 1000);
3148 EMACS_TIME wakeup = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), delay);
3149
3150 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3151 available. */
3152 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3153 {
3154 EMACS_TIME current = current_emacs_time ();
3155 EMACS_TIME timeout;
3156
3157 /* Break if result would not be positive. */
3158 if (EMACS_TIME_LE (wakeup, current))
3159 break;
3160
3161 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3162 timeout = make_emacs_time (0, 10 * 1000 * 1000);
3163
3164 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3165 pselect (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout, NULL);
3166 }
3167 }
3168
3169 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3170 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3171 {
3172 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3173 flash_left,
3174 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3175 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3176 width, flash_height);
3177 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3178 flash_left,
3179 (height - flash_height
3180 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3181 width, flash_height);
3182 }
3183 else
3184 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3185 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3186 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3187 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3188
3189 #ifdef USE_GTK
3190 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3191 cairo_destroy (cr);
3192 #else
3193 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3194 #endif
3195 #undef XFillRectangle
3196 #else
3197 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3198 #endif
3199 x_flush (f);
3200 }
3201 }
3202
3203 unblock_input ();
3204 }
3205
3206
3207 static void
3208 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3209 {
3210 block_input ();
3211 if (invisible)
3212 {
3213 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3214 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3215 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3216 }
3217 else
3218 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3219 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3220 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3221 unblock_input ();
3222 }
3223
3224
3225 /* Make audible bell. */
3226
3227 static void
3228 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3229 {
3230 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3231 {
3232 if (visible_bell)
3233 XTflash (f);
3234 else
3235 {
3236 block_input ();
3237 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3238 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3239 unblock_input ();
3240 }
3241 }
3242 }
3243
3244 \f
3245 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3246 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3247 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3248 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3249
3250 static void
3251 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3252 {
3253 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3254 }
3255
3256
3257 \f
3258 /***********************************************************************
3259 Line Dance
3260 ***********************************************************************/
3261
3262 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3263 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3264
3265 static void
3266 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3267 {
3268 emacs_abort ();
3269 }
3270
3271
3272 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3273
3274 static void
3275 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3276 {
3277 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3278 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3279
3280 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3281 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3282 fringe of W. */
3283 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3284
3285 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3286 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3287 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3288 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3289 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
3290 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
3291 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
3292 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
3293 {
3294 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
3295
3296 if (sb_width > 0)
3297 {
3298 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
3299 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
3300 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
3301
3302 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == x)
3303 {
3304 x = bar_area_x + sb_width;
3305 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3306 }
3307 else if (x + width == bar_area_x)
3308 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3309 }
3310 }
3311 #endif
3312
3313 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3314 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3315 bottom_y = y + height;
3316
3317 if (to_y < from_y)
3318 {
3319 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3320 line at the bottom. */
3321 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3322 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3323 else
3324 height = run->height;
3325 }
3326 else
3327 {
3328 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3329 at the bottom. */
3330 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3331 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3332 else
3333 height = run->height;
3334 }
3335
3336 block_input ();
3337
3338 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3339 updated_window = w;
3340 x_clear_cursor (w);
3341
3342 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3343 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3344 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3345 x, from_y,
3346 width, height,
3347 x, to_y);
3348
3349 unblock_input ();
3350 }
3351
3352
3353 \f
3354 /***********************************************************************
3355 Exposure Events
3356 ***********************************************************************/
3357
3358 \f
3359 static void
3360 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3361 {
3362 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3363 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3364 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3365 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3366 block_input ();
3367 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3368 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3369 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3370 because of this (bug#9310). */
3371 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3372 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3373 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3374 x_uncatch_errors ();
3375 unblock_input ();
3376 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3377 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3378 }
3379
3380 static void
3381 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3382 {
3383 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3384 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3385 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3386 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3387 block_input ();
3388 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3389 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3390 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3391 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3392 x_uncatch_errors ();
3393 unblock_input ();
3394 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3395 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3396 }
3397
3398 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3399 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3400 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3401 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3402 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3403
3404 static void
3405 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3406 {
3407 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3408
3409 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3410 {
3411 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3412 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3413 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3414
3415 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3416 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3417
3418 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3419 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3420 else
3421 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3422 }
3423
3424 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3425 }
3426
3427 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3428 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3429 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3430
3431 static void
3432 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3433 {
3434 if (type == FocusIn)
3435 {
3436 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3437 {
3438 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3439 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3440
3441 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3442 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3443 /* When run as a daemon, Vterminal_frame is always NIL. */
3444 if ((NILP (Vterminal_frame) || EQ (Fdaemonp(), Qt))
3445 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3446 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3447 {
3448 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3449 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3450 }
3451 }
3452
3453 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3454
3455 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3456 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3457 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3458 #endif
3459 }
3460 else if (type == FocusOut)
3461 {
3462 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3463
3464 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3465 {
3466 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3467 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3468 }
3469
3470 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3471 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3472 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3473 #endif
3474 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3475 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3476 }
3477 }
3478
3479 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3480 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3481
3482 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3483
3484 static void
3485 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3486 {
3487 struct frame *frame;
3488
3489 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3490 if (! frame)
3491 return;
3492
3493 switch (event->type)
3494 {
3495 case EnterNotify:
3496 case LeaveNotify:
3497 {
3498 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3499 int focus_state
3500 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3501
3502 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3503 && event->xcrossing.focus
3504 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3505 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3506 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3507 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3508 }
3509 break;
3510
3511 case FocusIn:
3512 case FocusOut:
3513 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3514 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3515 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3516 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3517 break;
3518
3519 case ClientMessage:
3520 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3521 {
3522 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3523 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3524 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3525 }
3526 break;
3527 }
3528 }
3529
3530
3531 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3532 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3533
3534 void
3535 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3536 {
3537 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3538 }
3539 #endif
3540
3541 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3542 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3543 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3544
3545 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3546 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3547 the appropriate X display info. */
3548
3549 static void
3550 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3551 {
3552 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3553 }
3554
3555 static void
3556 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3557 {
3558 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3559
3560 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3561 {
3562 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3563 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3564 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3565 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3566 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3567 {
3568 fset_focus_frame (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame, Qnil);
3569 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3570 }
3571 }
3572 else
3573 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3574
3575 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3576 {
3577 if (old_highlight)
3578 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3579 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3580 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3581 }
3582 }
3583
3584
3585 \f
3586 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3587
3588 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3589 static void
3590 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3591 {
3592 int min_code, max_code;
3593 KeySym *syms;
3594 int syms_per_code;
3595 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3596
3597 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3598 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3599 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3600 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3601 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3602
3603 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3604
3605 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3606 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3607 &syms_per_code);
3608 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3609
3610 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3611 Alt keysyms are on. */
3612 {
3613 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3614 int found_alt_or_meta;
3615
3616 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3617 {
3618 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3619 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3620 {
3621 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3622
3623 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3624 if (code == 0)
3625 continue;
3626
3627 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3628 {
3629 int code_col;
3630
3631 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3632 {
3633 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3634
3635 switch (sym)
3636 {
3637 case XK_Meta_L:
3638 case XK_Meta_R:
3639 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3640 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3641 break;
3642
3643 case XK_Alt_L:
3644 case XK_Alt_R:
3645 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3646 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3647 break;
3648
3649 case XK_Hyper_L:
3650 case XK_Hyper_R:
3651 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3652 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3653 code_col = syms_per_code;
3654 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3655 break;
3656
3657 case XK_Super_L:
3658 case XK_Super_R:
3659 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3660 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3661 code_col = syms_per_code;
3662 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3663 break;
3664
3665 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3666 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3667 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3668 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3669 code_col = syms_per_code;
3670 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3671 break;
3672 }
3673 }
3674 }
3675 }
3676 }
3677 }
3678
3679 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3680 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3681 {
3682 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3683 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3684 }
3685
3686 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3687 make them just meta, not alt. */
3688 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3689 {
3690 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3691 }
3692
3693 XFree (syms);
3694 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3695 }
3696
3697 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3698 Emacs uses. */
3699
3700 int
3701 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
3702 {
3703 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3704 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3705 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3706 int mod_super = super_modifier;
3707 Lisp_Object tem;
3708
3709 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3710 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3711 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3712 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3713 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3714 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3715 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3716 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3717
3718 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3719 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3720 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3721 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3722 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3723 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3724 }
3725
3726 static int
3727 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
3728 {
3729 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3730 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3731 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3732 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
3733
3734 Lisp_Object tem;
3735
3736 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3737 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3738 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3739 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3740 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3741 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3742 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3743 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3744
3745
3746 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3747 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3748 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3749 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3750 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3751 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3752 }
3753
3754 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3755
3756 char *
3757 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3758 {
3759 char *value;
3760
3761 block_input ();
3762 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3763 unblock_input ();
3764
3765 return value;
3766 }
3767
3768
3769 \f
3770 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3771
3772 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3773
3774 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3775 the mouse. */
3776
3777 static Lisp_Object
3778 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3779 {
3780 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3781 otherwise. */
3782 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3783 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3784 result->timestamp = event->time;
3785 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3786 event->state)
3787 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3788 ? up_modifier
3789 : down_modifier));
3790
3791 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3792 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3793 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3794 result->arg = Qnil;
3795 return Qnil;
3796 }
3797
3798 \f
3799 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3800 The input handler calls this.
3801
3802 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3803 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3804 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3805 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3806
3807 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3808 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3809
3810 static int
3811 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3812 {
3813 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3814 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3815 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3816
3817 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3818 return 0;
3819
3820 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3821 {
3822 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3823 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3824 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3825 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3826 return 1;
3827 }
3828
3829
3830 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3831 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3832 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3833 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3834 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3835 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3836 {
3837 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3838 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3839 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3840 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3841 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3842 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3843 return 1;
3844 }
3845
3846 return 0;
3847 }
3848
3849 \f
3850 /************************************************************************
3851 Mouse Face
3852 ************************************************************************/
3853
3854 static void
3855 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3856 {
3857 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3858 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3859 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3860 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3861 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3862 }
3863
3864
3865
3866 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3867 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3868
3869 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3870 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3871 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3872 position on the scroll bar.
3873
3874 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3875 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3876 the mouse is over.
3877
3878 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3879 was at this position.
3880
3881 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3882
3883 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3884 movement. */
3885
3886 static void
3887 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3888 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3889 Time *timestamp)
3890 {
3891 FRAME_PTR f1;
3892
3893 block_input ();
3894
3895 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3896 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3897 else
3898 {
3899 Window root;
3900 int root_x, root_y;
3901
3902 Window dummy_window;
3903 int dummy;
3904
3905 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3906
3907 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3908 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3909 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3910 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3911 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3912
3913 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3914
3915 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3916 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3917 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3918
3919 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3920 &root,
3921
3922 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3923 a different screen. */
3924 &dummy_window,
3925
3926 /* The position on that root window. */
3927 &root_x, &root_y,
3928
3929 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3930 &dummy, &dummy,
3931
3932 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3933 we don't care. */
3934 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3935
3936 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3937 containing the pointer. */
3938 {
3939 Window win, child;
3940 int win_x, win_y;
3941 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3942
3943 win = root;
3944
3945 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3946 structure is changing at the same time this function
3947 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3948
3949 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3950
3951 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3952 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3953 {
3954 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3955 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3956 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3957
3958 /* From-window, to-window. */
3959 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3960
3961 /* From-position, to-position. */
3962 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3963
3964 /* Child of win. */
3965 &child);
3966 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3967 }
3968 else
3969 {
3970 while (1)
3971 {
3972 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3973
3974 /* From-window, to-window. */
3975 root, win,
3976
3977 /* From-position, to-position. */
3978 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3979
3980 /* Child of win. */
3981 &child);
3982
3983 if (child == None || child == win)
3984 break;
3985 #ifdef USE_GTK
3986 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3987 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3988 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3989 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3990 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3991 break;
3992 #endif
3993 win = child;
3994 parent_x = win_x;
3995 parent_y = win_y;
3996 }
3997
3998 /* Now we know that:
3999 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
4000 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
4001 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
4002 (XTC did this the last time through), and
4003 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
4004 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
4005 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
4006 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
4007 never use them in that case.) */
4008
4009 #ifdef USE_GTK
4010 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4011 want the edit window. */
4012 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4013 #else
4014 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4015 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4016 #endif
4017
4018 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4019 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4020 on the frame. */
4021 if (f1 != NULL
4022 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4023 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4024 f1 = NULL;
4025 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4026 }
4027
4028 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4029 f1 = 0;
4030
4031 x_uncatch_errors ();
4032
4033 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4034 if (! f1)
4035 {
4036 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4037
4038 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
4039
4040 if (bar)
4041 {
4042 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4043 win_x = parent_x;
4044 win_y = parent_y;
4045 }
4046 }
4047
4048 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4049 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4050
4051 if (f1)
4052 {
4053 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4054 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4055 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4056 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4057 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4058 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4059 the frame are divided into. */
4060
4061 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4062 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4063
4064 *bar_window = Qnil;
4065 *part = 0;
4066 *fp = f1;
4067 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4068 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4069 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
4070 }
4071 }
4072 }
4073
4074 unblock_input ();
4075 }
4076
4077
4078 \f
4079 /***********************************************************************
4080 Scroll bars
4081 ***********************************************************************/
4082
4083 /* Scroll bar support. */
4084
4085 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4086 manages it.
4087 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4088 bits. */
4089
4090 static struct scroll_bar *
4091 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4092 {
4093 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4094
4095 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4096 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4097 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4098
4099 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4100 {
4101 Lisp_Object bar, condemned;
4102
4103 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4104 continue;
4105
4106 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4107 right window ID. */
4108 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4109 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4110 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4111 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4112 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4113 condemned = Qnil,
4114 ! NILP (bar));
4115 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4116 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4117 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4118 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4119 }
4120
4121 return NULL;
4122 }
4123
4124
4125 #if defined USE_LUCID
4126
4127 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4128 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4129
4130 static Widget
4131 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4132 {
4133 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4134
4135 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4136 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4137 {
4138 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4139
4140 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4141 return menu_bar;
4142 }
4143 return NULL;
4144 }
4145
4146 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4147
4148 \f
4149 /************************************************************************
4150 Toolkit scroll bars
4151 ************************************************************************/
4152
4153 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4154
4155 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4156 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4157 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4158 struct scroll_bar *);
4159 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4160 int, int, int);
4161
4162
4163 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4164 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4165
4166 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4167
4168 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4169
4170 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4171
4172 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4173 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4174
4175 #ifndef USE_GTK
4176 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4177
4178 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4179
4180 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4181
4182 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4183 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4184 to avoid jerkiness. */
4185
4186 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4187
4188 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4189 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4190 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4191 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4192
4193 static void
4194 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4195 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4196 {
4197 int scroll_bar_p;
4198 const char *end_action;
4199
4200 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4201 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4202 end_action = "Release";
4203 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4204 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4205 end_action = "EndScroll";
4206 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4207
4208 if (scroll_bar_p
4209 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4210 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4211 {
4212 struct window *w;
4213
4214 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4215 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4216 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4217
4218 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4219 {
4220 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4221 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4222 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4223 }
4224 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4225 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4226
4227 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4228 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4229 }
4230 }
4231 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4232
4233 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4234 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4235
4236 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4237 static ptrdiff_t scroll_bar_windows_size;
4238
4239
4240 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4241 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4242 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4243 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4244
4245 static void
4246 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4247 {
4248 XEvent event;
4249 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4250 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4251 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4252 ptrdiff_t i;
4253
4254 block_input ();
4255
4256 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4257 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4258 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4259 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4260 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4261 ev->format = 32;
4262
4263 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4264 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4265 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4266 into that array in the event. */
4267 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4268 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4269 break;
4270
4271 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4272 {
4273 ptrdiff_t old_nbytes =
4274 scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4275 ptrdiff_t nbytes;
4276 enum { XClientMessageEvent_MAX = 0x7fffffff };
4277 scroll_bar_windows =
4278 xpalloc (scroll_bar_windows, &scroll_bar_windows_size, 1,
4279 XClientMessageEvent_MAX, sizeof *scroll_bar_windows);
4280 nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4281 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4282 }
4283
4284 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4285 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4286 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4287 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4288 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4289 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4290
4291 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4292 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4293 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4294 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4295 #endif
4296
4297 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4298 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4299 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4300 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4301 unblock_input ();
4302 }
4303
4304
4305 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4306 in *IEVENT. */
4307
4308 static void
4309 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4310 {
4311 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4312 Lisp_Object window;
4313 struct window *w;
4314
4315 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4316 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4317
4318 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4319
4320 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4321 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4322 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4323 #ifdef USE_GTK
4324 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4325 #else
4326 ievent->timestamp =
4327 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4328 #endif
4329 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4330 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4331 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4332 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4333 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4334 }
4335
4336
4337 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4338
4339 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4340
4341 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4342
4343
4344 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4345 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4346 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4347
4348 static void
4349 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4350 {
4351 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4352 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4353 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4354
4355 switch (cs->reason)
4356 {
4357 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4358 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4359 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4360 break;
4361
4362 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4363 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4364 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4365 break;
4366
4367 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4368 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4369 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4370 break;
4371
4372 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4373 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4374 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4375 break;
4376
4377 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4378 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4379 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4380 break;
4381
4382 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4383 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4384 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4385 break;
4386
4387 case XmCR_DRAG:
4388 {
4389 int slider_size;
4390
4391 /* Get the slider size. */
4392 block_input ();
4393 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4394 unblock_input ();
4395
4396 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4397 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4398 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4399 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4400 }
4401 break;
4402
4403 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4404 break;
4405 };
4406
4407 if (part >= 0)
4408 {
4409 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4410 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4411 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4412 }
4413 }
4414
4415 #elif defined USE_GTK
4416
4417 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4418 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4419
4420 static gboolean
4421 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4422 GtkScrollType scroll,
4423 gdouble value,
4424 gpointer user_data)
4425 {
4426 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4427 gdouble position;
4428 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4429 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4430 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4431
4432 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4433 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4434
4435
4436 switch (scroll)
4437 {
4438 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4439 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4440 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4441 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4442 {
4443 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4444 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4445 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4446 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4447 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4448 }
4449 break;
4450 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4451 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4452 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4453 break;
4454 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4455 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4456 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4457 break;
4458 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4459 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4460 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4461 break;
4462 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4463 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4464 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4465 break;
4466 }
4467
4468 if (part >= 0)
4469 {
4470 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4471 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4472 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4473 }
4474
4475 return FALSE;
4476 }
4477
4478 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4479
4480 static gboolean
4481 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4482 GdkEventButton *event,
4483 gpointer user_data)
4484 {
4485 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4486 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4487 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4488 {
4489 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4490 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4491 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4492 }
4493
4494 return FALSE;
4495 }
4496
4497
4498 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4499
4500 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4501 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4502 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4503 the thumb is. */
4504
4505 static void
4506 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4507 {
4508 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4509 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4510 float shown;
4511 int whole, portion, height;
4512 int part;
4513
4514 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4515 block_input ();
4516 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4517 unblock_input ();
4518
4519 whole = 10000000;
4520 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4521
4522 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0f / height))
4523 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4524 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4525 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4526 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4527 bottom). */
4528 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4529 else
4530 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4531
4532 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4533 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4534 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4535 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4536 }
4537
4538
4539 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4540 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4541 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4542 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4543 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4544 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4545 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4546
4547 static void
4548 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4549 {
4550 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4551 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4552 int position = (long) call_data;
4553 Dimension height;
4554 int part;
4555
4556 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4557 block_input ();
4558 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4559 unblock_input ();
4560
4561 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4562 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4563
4564 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4565 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4566 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4567 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4568 else
4569 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4570
4571 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4572 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4573 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4574 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4575 }
4576
4577 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4578
4579 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4580
4581 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4582 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4583
4584 #ifdef USE_GTK
4585 static void
4586 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4587 {
4588 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4589
4590 block_input ();
4591 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4592 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4593 scroll_bar_name);
4594 unblock_input ();
4595 }
4596
4597 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4598
4599 static void
4600 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4601 {
4602 Window xwindow;
4603 Widget widget;
4604 Arg av[20];
4605 int ac = 0;
4606 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4607 unsigned long pixel;
4608
4609 block_input ();
4610
4611 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4612 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4613 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4614 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4615 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4616 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4617 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4618 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4619 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4620
4621 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4622 if (pixel != -1)
4623 {
4624 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4625 ++ac;
4626 }
4627
4628 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4629 if (pixel != -1)
4630 {
4631 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4632 ++ac;
4633 }
4634
4635 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4636 (char *) scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4637
4638 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4639 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4640 (XtPointer) bar);
4641 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4642 (XtPointer) bar);
4643 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4644 (XtPointer) bar);
4645 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4646 (XtPointer) bar);
4647 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4648 (XtPointer) bar);
4649 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4650 (XtPointer) bar);
4651 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4652 (XtPointer) bar);
4653
4654 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4655 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4656
4657 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4658 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4659 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4660 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4661
4662 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4663
4664 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4665 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4666 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4667 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4668 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4669 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4670 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4671 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4672
4673 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4674 if (pixel != -1)
4675 {
4676 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4677 ++ac;
4678 }
4679
4680 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4681 if (pixel != -1)
4682 {
4683 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4684 ++ac;
4685 }
4686
4687 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4688
4689 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4690 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4691 {
4692 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4693 if (pixel != -1)
4694 {
4695 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4696 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4697 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4698 pixel = -1;
4699 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4700 }
4701 }
4702 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4703 {
4704 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4705 if (pixel != -1)
4706 {
4707 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4708 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4709 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4710 pixel = -1;
4711 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4712 }
4713 }
4714
4715 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4716 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4717 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4718 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4719 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4720 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4721 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4722 colors itself. */
4723 {
4724 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4725 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4726 ++ac;
4727 }
4728 else
4729 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4730 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4731 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4732 {
4733 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4734 the shadows. */
4735 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4736 ++ac;
4737
4738 /* Specify the colors. */
4739 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4740 if (pixel != -1)
4741 {
4742 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4743 ++ac;
4744 }
4745 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4746 if (pixel != -1)
4747 {
4748 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4749 ++ac;
4750 }
4751 }
4752 #endif
4753
4754 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4755 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4756
4757 {
4758 char const *initial = "";
4759 char const *val = initial;
4760 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4761 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4762 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4763 #endif
4764 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4765 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4766 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4767 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4768 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4769 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4770 }
4771 }
4772
4773 /* Define callbacks. */
4774 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4775 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4776 (XtPointer) bar);
4777
4778 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4779 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4780
4781 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4782
4783 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4784 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4785 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4786 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4787
4788 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4789 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4790 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4791 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4792
4793 unblock_input ();
4794 }
4795 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4796
4797
4798 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4799 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4800
4801 #ifdef USE_GTK
4802 static void
4803 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4804 {
4805 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4806 }
4807
4808 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4809 static void
4810 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4811 int whole)
4812 {
4813 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4814 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4815 float top, shown;
4816
4817 block_input ();
4818
4819 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4820
4821 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4822 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4823 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4824 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4825 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4826 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4827 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4828 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4829 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4830 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4831 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4832 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4833 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4834 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4835 whole += portion;
4836
4837 if (whole <= 0)
4838 top = 0, shown = 1;
4839 else
4840 {
4841 top = (float) position / whole;
4842 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4843 }
4844
4845 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4846 {
4847 int size, value;
4848
4849 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4850 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4851 value. */
4852 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4853 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4854 size = max (size, 1);
4855
4856 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4857 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4858 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4859
4860 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4861 }
4862 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4863
4864 if (whole == 0)
4865 top = 0, shown = 1;
4866 else
4867 {
4868 top = (float) position / whole;
4869 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4870 }
4871
4872 {
4873 float old_top, old_shown;
4874 Dimension height;
4875 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4876 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4877 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4878 XtNheight, &height,
4879 NULL);
4880
4881 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4882 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4883 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4884 else
4885 top = old_top;
4886 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4887 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0f / height), shown));
4888
4889 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4890 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4891 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4892 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4893 {
4894 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4895 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4896 else
4897 {
4898 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4899 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4900 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4901
4902 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4903 }
4904 }
4905 }
4906 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4907
4908 unblock_input ();
4909 }
4910 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4911
4912 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4913
4914
4915 \f
4916 /************************************************************************
4917 Scroll bars, general
4918 ************************************************************************/
4919
4920 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4921 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4922 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4923 scroll bar. */
4924
4925 static struct scroll_bar *
4926 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4927 {
4928 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4929 struct scroll_bar *bar
4930 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4931 Lisp_Object barobj;
4932
4933 block_input ();
4934
4935 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4936 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4937 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4938 {
4939 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4940 unsigned long mask;
4941 Window window;
4942
4943 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4944 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4945 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4946
4947 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4948 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4949 | ExposureMask);
4950 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4951
4952 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4953
4954 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4955 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4956 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4957 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4958 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4959 left, top, width,
4960 window_box_height (w), False);
4961
4962 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4963 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4964 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4965 top,
4966 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4967 height,
4968 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4969 0,
4970 CopyFromParent,
4971 CopyFromParent,
4972 CopyFromParent,
4973 /* Attributes. */
4974 mask, &a);
4975 bar->x_window = window;
4976 }
4977 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4978
4979 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4980 bar->top = top;
4981 bar->left = left;
4982 bar->width = width;
4983 bar->height = height;
4984 bar->start = 0;
4985 bar->end = 0;
4986 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4987 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4988
4989 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4990 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4991 bar->prev = Qnil;
4992 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
4993 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
4994 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4995 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4996
4997 /* Map the window/widget. */
4998 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4999 {
5000 #ifdef USE_GTK
5001 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5002 bar->x_window,
5003 top,
5004 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5005 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5006 max (height, 1));
5007 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5008 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
5009 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
5010 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5011 top,
5012 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5013 max (height, 1), 0);
5014 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
5015 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5016 }
5017 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5018 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5019 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5020
5021 unblock_input ();
5022 return bar;
5023 }
5024
5025
5026 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5027
5028 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5029
5030 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5031 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5032 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5033 events.)
5034
5035 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5036 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5037 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5038 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5039 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5040
5041 static void
5042 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
5043 {
5044 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5045 Window w = bar->x_window;
5046 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5047 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5048
5049 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5050 if (! rebuild
5051 && start == bar->start
5052 && end == bar->end)
5053 return;
5054
5055 block_input ();
5056
5057 {
5058 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5059 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5060 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5061
5062 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5063 the distance between start and end. */
5064 {
5065 int length = end - start;
5066
5067 if (start < 0)
5068 start = 0;
5069 else if (start > top_range)
5070 start = top_range;
5071 end = start + length;
5072
5073 if (end < start)
5074 end = start;
5075 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5076 end = top_range;
5077 }
5078
5079 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5080 bar->start = start;
5081 bar->end = end;
5082
5083 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5084 if (end > top_range)
5085 end = top_range;
5086
5087 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5088 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5089 that many pixels tall. */
5090 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5091
5092 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5093 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5094 if (0 < start)
5095 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5096 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5097 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5098 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5099 inside_width, start,
5100 False);
5101
5102 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5103 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5104 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5105 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5106
5107 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5108 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5109 /* x, y, width, height */
5110 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5111 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5112 inside_width, end - start);
5113
5114 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5115 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5116 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5117 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5118
5119 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5120 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5121 if (end < inside_height)
5122 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5123 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5124 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5125 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5126 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5127 False);
5128
5129 }
5130
5131 unblock_input ();
5132 }
5133
5134 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5135
5136 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5137 nil. */
5138
5139 static void
5140 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5141 {
5142 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5143 block_input ();
5144
5145 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5146 #ifdef USE_GTK
5147 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5148 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5149 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5150 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5151 #else
5152 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5153 #endif
5154
5155 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5156 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (XWINDOW (bar->window), Qnil);
5157
5158 unblock_input ();
5159 }
5160
5161
5162 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5163 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5164 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5165 create one. */
5166
5167 static void
5168 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5169 {
5170 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5171 Lisp_Object barobj;
5172 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5173 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5174 int window_y, window_height;
5175 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5176 int fringe_extended_p;
5177 #endif
5178
5179 /* Get window dimensions. */
5180 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5181 top = window_y;
5182 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5183 height = window_height;
5184
5185 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5186 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5187
5188 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5189 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5190 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5191 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5192 else
5193 sb_width = width;
5194
5195 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5196 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5197 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5198 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5199 else
5200 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5201 #else
5202 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5203 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5204 else
5205 sb_left = left;
5206 #endif
5207
5208 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5209 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5210 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5211 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5212 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5213 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5214 else
5215 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5216 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5217 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5218 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5219 #endif
5220
5221 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5222 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5223 {
5224 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5225 {
5226 block_input ();
5227 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5228 if (fringe_extended_p)
5229 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5230 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5231 else
5232 #endif
5233 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5234 left, top, width, height, False);
5235 unblock_input ();
5236 }
5237
5238 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5239 }
5240 else
5241 {
5242 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5243 unsigned int mask = 0;
5244
5245 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5246
5247 block_input ();
5248
5249 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5250 mask |= CWX;
5251 if (top != bar->top)
5252 mask |= CWY;
5253 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5254 mask |= CWWidth;
5255 if (height != bar->height)
5256 mask |= CWHeight;
5257
5258 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5259
5260 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5261 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5262 {
5263 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5264 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5265 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5266 {
5267 if (fringe_extended_p)
5268 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5269 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5270 else
5271 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5272 left, top, width, height, False);
5273 }
5274 #ifdef USE_GTK
5275 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5276 bar->x_window,
5277 top,
5278 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5279 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5280 max (height, 1));
5281 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5282 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5283 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5284 top,
5285 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5286 max (height, 1), 0);
5287 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5288 }
5289 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5290
5291 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5292 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5293 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5294 {
5295 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5296 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5297 height, False);
5298 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5299 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5300 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5301 height, False);
5302 }
5303
5304 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5305 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5306 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5307 example. */
5308 {
5309 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5310 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5311 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5312 {
5313 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5314 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5315 left + area_width - rest, top,
5316 rest, height, False);
5317 else
5318 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5319 left, top, rest, height, False);
5320 }
5321 }
5322
5323 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5324 if (mask)
5325 {
5326 XWindowChanges wc;
5327
5328 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5329 wc.y = top;
5330 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5331 wc.height = height;
5332 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5333 mask, &wc);
5334 }
5335
5336 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5337
5338 /* Remember new settings. */
5339 bar->left = sb_left;
5340 bar->top = top;
5341 bar->width = sb_width;
5342 bar->height = height;
5343
5344 unblock_input ();
5345 }
5346
5347 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5348 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5349
5350 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5351 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5352 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5353 dragged. */
5354 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5355 {
5356 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5357
5358 if (whole == 0)
5359 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5360 else
5361 {
5362 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5363 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5364 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5365 }
5366 }
5367 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5368
5369 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5370 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, barobj);
5371 }
5372
5373
5374 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5375 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5376 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5377 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5378 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5379 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5380 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5381
5382 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5383 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5384 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5385
5386 static void
5387 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5388 {
5389 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5390 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5391 {
5392 Lisp_Object bar;
5393 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5394 fset_scroll_bars (frame, XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next);
5395 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5396 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5397 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5398 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5399 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (frame, bar);
5400 }
5401 }
5402
5403
5404 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5405 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5406
5407 static void
5408 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5409 {
5410 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5411 struct frame *f;
5412 Lisp_Object barobj;
5413
5414 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5415 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5416 emacs_abort ();
5417
5418 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5419
5420 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5421 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5422 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5423 {
5424 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5425 the lists. */
5426 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5427 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5428 return;
5429 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5430 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5431 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, bar->next);
5432 else
5433 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5434 one or the other! */
5435 emacs_abort ();
5436 }
5437 else
5438 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5439
5440 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5441 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5442
5443 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5444 bar->prev = Qnil;
5445 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5446 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
5447 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5448 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5449 }
5450
5451 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5452 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5453
5454 static void
5455 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5456 {
5457 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5458
5459 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5460
5461 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5462 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5463 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, Qnil);
5464
5465 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5466 {
5467 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5468
5469 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5470
5471 next = b->next;
5472 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5473 }
5474
5475 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5476 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5477 }
5478
5479
5480 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5481 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5482 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5483
5484 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5485 mark bits. */
5486
5487 static void
5488 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5489 {
5490 Window w = bar->x_window;
5491 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5492 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5493 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5494
5495 block_input ();
5496
5497 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5498
5499 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5500 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5501 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5502 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5503
5504 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5505 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5506
5507 /* x, y, width, height */
5508 0, 0,
5509 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5510 bar->height - 1);
5511
5512 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5513 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5514 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5515 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5516
5517 unblock_input ();
5518
5519 }
5520 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5521
5522 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5523 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5524
5525 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5526 mark bits. */
5527
5528
5529 static void
5530 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5531 {
5532 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5533 emacs_abort ();
5534
5535 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5536 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5537 emacs_event->modifiers
5538 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5539 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5540 event->xbutton.state)
5541 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5542 ? up_modifier
5543 : down_modifier));
5544 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5545 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5546 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5547 {
5548 int top_range
5549 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5550 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5551
5552 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5553 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5554
5555 if (y < bar->start)
5556 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5557 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5558 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5559 else
5560 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5561
5562 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5563 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5564 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5565 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5566 {
5567 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5568 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5569
5570 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5571 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5572 }
5573 #endif
5574
5575 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5576 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5577 }
5578 }
5579
5580 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5581
5582 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5583
5584 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5585 mark bits. */
5586
5587 static void
5588 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5589 {
5590 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5591
5592 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5593
5594 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5595 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5596
5597 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5598 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5599 {
5600 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5601 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5602
5603 if (new_start != bar->start)
5604 {
5605 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5606
5607 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5608 }
5609 }
5610 }
5611
5612 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5613
5614 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5615 on the scroll bar. */
5616
5617 static void
5618 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5619 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5620 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
5621 {
5622 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5623 Window w = bar->x_window;
5624 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5625 int win_x, win_y;
5626 Window dummy_window;
5627 int dummy_coord;
5628 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5629
5630 block_input ();
5631
5632 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5633 report that. */
5634 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5635
5636 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5637 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5638 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5639
5640 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5641 &win_x, &win_y,
5642
5643 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5644 &dummy_mask))
5645 ;
5646 else
5647 {
5648 int top_range
5649 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5650
5651 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5652
5653 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5654 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5655
5656 if (win_y < 0)
5657 win_y = 0;
5658 if (win_y > top_range)
5659 win_y = top_range;
5660
5661 *fp = f;
5662 *bar_window = bar->window;
5663
5664 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5665 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5666 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5667 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5668 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5669 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5670 else
5671 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5672
5673 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5674 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5675
5676 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5677 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5678 }
5679
5680 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5681
5682 unblock_input ();
5683 }
5684
5685
5686 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5687 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5688 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5689 redraw them. */
5690
5691 static void
5692 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5693 {
5694 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5695 Lisp_Object bar;
5696
5697 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5698 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5699 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5700 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5701 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5702 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5703 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5704 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5705 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5706 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5707 }
5708
5709 \f
5710 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5711
5712 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5713 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5714 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5715 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5716
5717 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5718 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5719
5720 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5721
5722 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5723 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5724
5725 static int temp_index;
5726 static short temp_buffer[100];
5727
5728 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5729 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5730 temp_index = 0; \
5731 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5732
5733 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5734 on a particular display. */
5735
5736 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5737
5738 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5739 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5740 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5741 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5742
5743 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5744
5745 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5746 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5747 do \
5748 { \
5749 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5750 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = \
5751 xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5752 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5753 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5754 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5755 } \
5756 while (0)
5757 #endif
5758
5759 enum
5760 {
5761 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5762 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5763 X_EVENT_DROP
5764 };
5765
5766 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5767 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5768 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5769
5770 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5771 this event further.
5772 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5773
5774 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5775 static int
5776 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5777 {
5778 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5779 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5780 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5781 was created. */
5782
5783 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5784 event->xclient.window);
5785
5786 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5787 }
5788 #endif
5789
5790 #ifdef USE_GTK
5791 static int current_count;
5792 static int current_finish;
5793 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5794
5795 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5796 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5797 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5798 static GdkFilterReturn
5799 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5800 {
5801 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5802
5803 block_input ();
5804 if (current_count >= 0)
5805 {
5806 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5807
5808 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5809
5810 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5811 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5812 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5813 so we do it here. */
5814 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5815 && dpyinfo
5816 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5817 {
5818 unblock_input ();
5819 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5820 }
5821 #endif
5822
5823 if (! dpyinfo)
5824 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5825 else
5826 current_count +=
5827 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5828 current_hold_quit);
5829 }
5830 else
5831 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5832
5833 unblock_input ();
5834
5835 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5836 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5837
5838 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5839 }
5840 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5841
5842
5843 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
5844 enum xembed_message,
5845 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5846
5847 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5848
5849 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5850 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5851 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5852
5853 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5854
5855 static int
5856 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5857 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5858 {
5859 union {
5860 struct input_event ie;
5861 struct selection_input_event sie;
5862 } inev;
5863 int count = 0;
5864 int do_help = 0;
5865 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
5866 struct frame *f = NULL;
5867 struct coding_system coding;
5868 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5869 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5870 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5871
5872 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5873
5874 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5875 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5876 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5877
5878 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5879 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5880
5881 switch (event.type)
5882 {
5883 case ClientMessage:
5884 {
5885 if (event.xclient.message_type
5886 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5887 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5888 {
5889 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5890 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5891 {
5892 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5893 could be the shell widget window
5894 if the frame has no title bar. */
5895 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5896 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5897 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5898 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5899 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5900 #endif
5901 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5902 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5903 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5904 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5905 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5906 needed.
5907
5908 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5909 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5910 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5911 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5912 Emacs. */
5913
5914 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5915 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5916 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5917 if (f)
5918 {
5919 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5920 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5921 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5922 x_catch_errors (d);
5923 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5924 /* The ICCCM says this is
5925 the only valid choice. */
5926 RevertToParent,
5927 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5928 /* This is needed to detect the error
5929 if there is an error. */
5930 XSync (d, False);
5931 x_uncatch_errors ();
5932 }
5933 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5934 #endif /* 0 */
5935 goto done;
5936 }
5937
5938 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5939 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5940 {
5941 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5942 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5943 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5944 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5945 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5946 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5947 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5948 session manager and one for this. */
5949 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5950 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5951 #endif
5952 {
5953 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5954 event.xclient.window);
5955 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5956 for a single Emacs process. */
5957 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5958 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5959 event.xclient.window,
5960 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5961 else if (f)
5962 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5963 event.xclient.window,
5964 0, 0);
5965 }
5966 goto done;
5967 }
5968
5969 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5970 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5971 {
5972 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5973 event.xclient.window);
5974 if (!f)
5975 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5976
5977 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5978 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5979 goto done;
5980 }
5981
5982 goto done;
5983 }
5984
5985 if (event.xclient.message_type
5986 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5987 {
5988 goto done;
5989 }
5990
5991 if (event.xclient.message_type
5992 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5993 {
5994 int new_x, new_y;
5995 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5996
5997 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5998 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5999
6000 if (f)
6001 {
6002 f->left_pos = new_x;
6003 f->top_pos = new_y;
6004 }
6005 goto done;
6006 }
6007
6008 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
6009 if (event.xclient.message_type
6010 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
6011 {
6012 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6013 if (f)
6014 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
6015 &event, NULL);
6016 goto done;
6017 }
6018 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6019
6020 if ((event.xclient.message_type
6021 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
6022 || (event.xclient.message_type
6023 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
6024 {
6025 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6026 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6027 currently never do because we are interested in
6028 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6029 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
6030 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6031 if (!f)
6032 goto OTHER;
6033 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6034 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6035 goto done;
6036 }
6037
6038 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6039 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6040 we construct an input_event. */
6041 if (event.xclient.message_type
6042 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6043 {
6044 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6045 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6046 goto done;
6047 }
6048 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6049
6050 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6051 if (event.xclient.message_type
6052 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6053 {
6054 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6055 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6056 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6057
6058 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6059 goto done;
6060 }
6061
6062 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6063
6064 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6065 if (!f)
6066 goto OTHER;
6067 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6068 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6069 }
6070 break;
6071
6072 case SelectionNotify:
6073 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6074 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6075 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6076 goto OTHER;
6077 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6078 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6079 break;
6080
6081 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6082 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6083 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6084 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6085 goto OTHER;
6086 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6087 {
6088 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionclear);
6089
6090 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6091 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6092 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6093 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6094 }
6095 break;
6096
6097 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6098 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6099 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6100 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6101 goto OTHER;
6102 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6103 {
6104 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionrequest);
6105
6106 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6107 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6108 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6109 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6110 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6111 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6112 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6113 }
6114 break;
6115
6116 case PropertyNotify:
6117 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6118 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6119 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6120 if (x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty) && f->iconified
6121 && f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen)
6122 {
6123 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed. It hides
6124 the frame. So if our state says we aren't hidden anymore,
6125 treat it as deiconified. */
6126 if (! f->async_iconified)
6127 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6128 f->async_visible = 1;
6129 f->async_iconified = 0;
6130 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6131 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 0;
6132 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6133 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6134 }
6135
6136 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6137 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6138 goto OTHER;
6139
6140 case ReparentNotify:
6141 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6142 if (f)
6143 {
6144 int x, y;
6145 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6146 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6147 f->left_pos = x;
6148 f->top_pos = y;
6149
6150 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6151 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6152 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6153
6154 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
6155 }
6156 goto OTHER;
6157
6158 case Expose:
6159 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6160 if (f)
6161 {
6162 #ifdef USE_GTK
6163 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6164 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6165 event.xexpose.window,
6166 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6167 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6168 FALSE);
6169 #endif
6170 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6171 {
6172 f->async_visible = 1;
6173 f->async_iconified = 0;
6174 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6175 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6176 }
6177 else
6178 expose_frame (f,
6179 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6180 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6181 }
6182 else
6183 {
6184 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6185 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6186 #endif
6187 #if defined USE_LUCID
6188 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6189 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6190 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6191 {
6192 Widget widget
6193 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6194 if (widget)
6195 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6196 }
6197 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6198
6199 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6200 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6201 goto OTHER;
6202 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6203 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6204 event.xexpose.window);
6205
6206 if (bar)
6207 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6208 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6209 else
6210 goto OTHER;
6211 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6212 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6213 }
6214 break;
6215
6216 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6217 source area was obscured or not
6218 available. */
6219 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6220 if (f)
6221 {
6222 expose_frame (f,
6223 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6224 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6225 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6226 }
6227 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6228 else
6229 goto OTHER;
6230 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6231 break;
6232
6233 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6234 source area was completely
6235 available. */
6236 break;
6237
6238 case UnmapNotify:
6239 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6240 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6241 {
6242 tip_window = 0;
6243 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6244 }
6245
6246 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6247 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6248 the frame was deleted. */
6249 {
6250 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6251 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6252 display that won't ever be seen. */
6253 f->async_visible = 0;
6254 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6255 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6256 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6257 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6258 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6259 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6260 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6261 {
6262 f->async_iconified = 1;
6263
6264 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6265 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6266 }
6267 }
6268 goto OTHER;
6269
6270 case MapNotify:
6271 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6272 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6273 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6274 goto OTHER;
6275
6276 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6277 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6278 frame is visible. */
6279 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6280 if (f)
6281 {
6282 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6283 the frame's display structures.
6284 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6285 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6286 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6287 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6288 if (! f->async_iconified)
6289 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6290
6291 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6292 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6293 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6294 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6295
6296 f->async_visible = 1;
6297 f->async_iconified = 0;
6298 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6299
6300 if (f->iconified)
6301 {
6302 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6303 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6304 }
6305 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6306 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6307 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6308 to update the frame titles
6309 in case this is the second frame. */
6310 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6311
6312 #ifdef USE_GTK
6313 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6314 #endif
6315 }
6316 goto OTHER;
6317
6318 case KeyPress:
6319
6320 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6321 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6322
6323 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6324 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6325 if (popup_activated ())
6326 goto OTHER;
6327 #endif
6328
6329 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6330
6331 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6332 mouse highlighting. */
6333 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6334 && (f == 0
6335 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6336 {
6337 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6338 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6339 }
6340
6341 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6342 if (f == 0)
6343 {
6344 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6345 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6346 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6347 event.xkey.window);
6348 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6349 {
6350 widget = XtParent (widget);
6351 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6352 }
6353 }
6354 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6355
6356 if (f != 0)
6357 {
6358 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6359 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6360 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6361 his Emacs hang.
6362
6363 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6364 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6365 status_return even if the input is too long to
6366 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6367 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6368 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6369 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6370 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6371 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6372 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6373 int modifiers;
6374 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6375 Lisp_Object c;
6376
6377 #ifdef USE_GTK
6378 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6379 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6380 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6381 (see above). */
6382 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6383 #endif
6384
6385 event.xkey.state
6386 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6387 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6388 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6389
6390 /* This will have to go some day... */
6391
6392 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6393 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6394 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6395 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6396 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6397 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6398 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6399
6400 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6401 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6402 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6403 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6404 not it is combined with Meta. */
6405 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6406 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6407
6408 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6409 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6410 {
6411 Status status_return;
6412
6413 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6414 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6415 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6416 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6417 &status_return);
6418 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6419 {
6420 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6421 copy_bufptr = alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6422 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6423 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6424 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6425 &status_return);
6426 }
6427 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6428 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6429 break;
6430 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6431 {
6432 keysym = NoSymbol;
6433 modifiers = 0;
6434 }
6435 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6436 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6437 emacs_abort ();
6438 }
6439 else
6440 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6441 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6442 &compose_status);
6443 #else
6444 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6445 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6446 &compose_status);
6447 #endif
6448
6449 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6450 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6451 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6452 break;
6453
6454 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6455 orig_keysym = keysym;
6456
6457 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6458 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6459 inev.ie.modifiers
6460 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6461 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6462
6463 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6464 translations to characters. */
6465 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6466 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6467 {
6468 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6469 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6470 goto done_keysym;
6471 }
6472
6473 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6474 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6475 {
6476 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6477 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6478 else
6479 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6480 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6481 goto done_keysym;
6482 }
6483
6484 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6485 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6486 && (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6487 Vx_keysym_table,
6488 Qnil),
6489 NATNUMP (c)))
6490 {
6491 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6492 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6493 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6494 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6495 goto done_keysym;
6496 }
6497
6498 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6499 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6500 || keysym == XK_Delete
6501 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6502 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6503 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6504 #endif
6505 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6506 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6507 #ifdef HPUX
6508 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6509 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6510 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6511 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6512 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
6513 #endif
6514 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6515 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6516 #endif
6517 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6518 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6519 #endif
6520 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6521 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6522 #endif
6523 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6524 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6525 #endif
6526 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6527 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6528 #endif
6529 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6530 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6531 #endif
6532 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6533 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6534 #endif
6535 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6536 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6537 #endif
6538 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6539 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6540 #endif
6541 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6542 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6543 #endif
6544 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6545 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6546 #endif
6547 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6548 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6549 #endif
6550 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6551 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6552 #endif
6553 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6554 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6555 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6556 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6557 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6558 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6559 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6560 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6561 don't have real modifiers but
6562 should be treated similarly to
6563 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6564 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6565 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
6566 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6567 #endif
6568 ))
6569 {
6570 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6571 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6572 key. */
6573 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6574 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6575 goto done_keysym;
6576 }
6577
6578 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6579 ptrdiff_t i;
6580 int nchars, len;
6581
6582 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6583 {
6584 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6585 nchars++;
6586 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6587 }
6588
6589 if (nchars < nbytes)
6590 {
6591 /* Decode the input data. */
6592
6593 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6594 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6595 we used just above and the locale. */
6596 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6597 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6598 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6599 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6600 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6601 gives us composition information. */
6602 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6603
6604 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
6605 nbytes);
6606 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6607 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6608 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6609 nbytes = coding.produced;
6610 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6611 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6612 }
6613
6614 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6615 character events. */
6616 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6617 {
6618 int ch;
6619 if (nchars == nbytes)
6620 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6621 else
6622 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6623 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6624 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6625 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6626 inev.ie.code = ch;
6627 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6628 }
6629
6630 count += nchars;
6631
6632 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6633
6634 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6635 break;
6636 }
6637 }
6638 done_keysym:
6639 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6640 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6641 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6642 client. */
6643 break;
6644 #else
6645 goto OTHER;
6646 #endif
6647
6648 case KeyRelease:
6649 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6650 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6651 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6652 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6653 client. */
6654 break;
6655 #else
6656 goto OTHER;
6657 #endif
6658
6659 case EnterNotify:
6660 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6661 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6662
6663 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6664
6665 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6666 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6667
6668 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6669 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6670 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6671 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6672 #ifdef USE_GTK
6673 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6674 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6675 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6676 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6677 #endif
6678 goto OTHER;
6679
6680 case FocusIn:
6681 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6682 goto OTHER;
6683
6684 case LeaveNotify:
6685 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6686 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6687
6688 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6689 if (f)
6690 {
6691 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6692 {
6693 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6694 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6695 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6696 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6697 }
6698
6699 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6700 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6701 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6702 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6703 if (any_help_event_p)
6704 do_help = -1;
6705 }
6706 #ifdef USE_GTK
6707 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6708 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6709 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6710 #endif
6711 goto OTHER;
6712
6713 case FocusOut:
6714 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6715 goto OTHER;
6716
6717 case MotionNotify:
6718 {
6719 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6720 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6721 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6722
6723 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6724 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6725 f = last_mouse_frame;
6726 else
6727 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6728
6729 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6730 {
6731 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6732 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6733 }
6734
6735 #ifdef USE_GTK
6736 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6737 f = 0;
6738 #endif
6739 if (f)
6740 {
6741
6742 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6743 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6744 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6745 {
6746 Lisp_Object window;
6747
6748 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6749 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6750 0, 0);
6751
6752 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6753 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6754 will be selected only when it is active. */
6755 if (WINDOWP (window)
6756 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6757 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6758 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6759 create event iff we don't leave the
6760 selected frame. */
6761 && (focus_follows_mouse
6762 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6763 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6764 {
6765 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6766 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6767 }
6768
6769 last_window=window;
6770 }
6771 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6772 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6773 }
6774 else
6775 {
6776 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6777 struct scroll_bar *bar
6778 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6779 event.xmotion.window);
6780
6781 if (bar)
6782 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6783 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6784
6785 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6786 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6787 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6788 }
6789
6790 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6791 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6792 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6793 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6794 do_help = 1;
6795 goto OTHER;
6796 }
6797
6798 case ConfigureNotify:
6799 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6800 #ifdef USE_GTK
6801 if (!f
6802 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6803 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6804 {
6805 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6806 event.xconfigure.height);
6807 f = 0;
6808 }
6809 #endif
6810 if (f)
6811 {
6812 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6813 #ifndef USE_GTK
6814 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6815 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6816
6817 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6818 is called by the code that handles resizing
6819 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6820
6821 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6822 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6823 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6824 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6825 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6826 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6827 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6828 {
6829 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6830 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6831 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6832 }
6833
6834 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6835 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6836 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6837 #endif
6838
6839 #ifdef USE_GTK
6840 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6841 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6842 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6843 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6844 #endif
6845 {
6846 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6847 }
6848
6849 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6850 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6851 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6852 #endif
6853
6854 }
6855 goto OTHER;
6856
6857 case ButtonRelease:
6858 case ButtonPress:
6859 {
6860 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6861 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6862 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6863
6864 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6865 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6866 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6867
6868 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6869 && last_mouse_frame
6870 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6871 f = last_mouse_frame;
6872 else
6873 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6874
6875 #ifdef USE_GTK
6876 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6877 f = 0;
6878 #endif
6879 if (f)
6880 {
6881 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6882 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6883 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6884 {
6885 Lisp_Object window;
6886 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6887 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6888
6889 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6890 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6891
6892 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6893 {
6894 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6895 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6896 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6897 event.xbutton.state));
6898 }
6899 }
6900
6901 if (!tool_bar_p)
6902 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6903 if (! popup_activated ())
6904 #endif
6905 {
6906 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6907 {
6908 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6909 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6910 {
6911 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6912 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6913 }
6914 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6915 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6916 }
6917 else
6918 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6919 }
6920 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6921 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6922 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6923 }
6924 else
6925 {
6926 struct scroll_bar *bar
6927 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6928 event.xbutton.window);
6929
6930 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6931 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6932 scroll bars. */
6933 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6934 {
6935 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6936 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6937 }
6938 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6939 if (bar)
6940 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6941 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6942 }
6943
6944 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6945 {
6946 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6947 last_mouse_frame = f;
6948
6949 if (!tool_bar_p)
6950 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6951 }
6952 else
6953 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6954
6955 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6956 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6957 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6958 if (f != 0)
6959 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6960
6961 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6962 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6963 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6964 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6965 Instead, save it away
6966 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6967 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6968 if (! popup_activated ()
6969 #ifdef USE_GTK
6970 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6971 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6972 #endif
6973 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6974 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6975 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6976 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6977 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6978 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6979 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6980 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6981 {
6982 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6983 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6984 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6985 }
6986 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6987 {
6988 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6989 goto OTHER;
6990 }
6991 else
6992 goto OTHER;
6993 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6994 }
6995 break;
6996
6997 case CirculateNotify:
6998 goto OTHER;
6999
7000 case CirculateRequest:
7001 goto OTHER;
7002
7003 case VisibilityNotify:
7004 goto OTHER;
7005
7006 case MappingNotify:
7007 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
7008 local cache. */
7009 switch (event.xmapping.request)
7010 {
7011 case MappingModifier:
7012 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
7013 /* This is meant to fall through. */
7014 case MappingKeyboard:
7015 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
7016 }
7017 goto OTHER;
7018
7019 case DestroyNotify:
7020 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
7021 break;
7022
7023 default:
7024 OTHER:
7025 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7026 block_input ();
7027 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7028 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7029 unblock_input ();
7030 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7031 break;
7032 }
7033
7034 done:
7035 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7036 {
7037 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7038 count++;
7039 }
7040
7041 if (do_help
7042 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7043 {
7044 Lisp_Object frame;
7045
7046 if (f)
7047 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7048 else
7049 frame = Qnil;
7050
7051 if (do_help > 0)
7052 {
7053 any_help_event_p = 1;
7054 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7055 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7056 }
7057 else
7058 {
7059 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7060 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7061 }
7062 count++;
7063 }
7064
7065 SAFE_FREE ();
7066 *eventptr = event;
7067 return count;
7068 }
7069
7070 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
7071
7072 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7073 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7074 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7075
7076 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7077 int
7078 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7079 {
7080 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7081 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7082
7083 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7084
7085 if (dpyinfo)
7086 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7087
7088 return finish;
7089 }
7090 #endif
7091
7092
7093 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7094 Return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7095
7096 Return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7097 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7098 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7099 C chars). */
7100
7101 static int
7102 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7103 {
7104 int count = 0;
7105 int event_found = 0;
7106
7107 block_input ();
7108
7109 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7110 input_signal_count++;
7111
7112 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7113 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7114 {
7115 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7116 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7117 }
7118
7119 #ifndef USE_GTK
7120 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7121 {
7122 int finish;
7123 XEvent event;
7124
7125 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7126
7127 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7128 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7129 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7130 continue;
7131 #endif
7132 event_found = 1;
7133
7134 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7135 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7136
7137 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7138 goto out;
7139 }
7140
7141 out:;
7142
7143 #else /* USE_GTK */
7144
7145 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7146 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7147 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7148 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7149
7150 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7151 from all displays. */
7152
7153 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7154 {
7155 current_count = count;
7156 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7157
7158 gtk_main_iteration ();
7159
7160 count = current_count;
7161 current_count = -1;
7162 current_hold_quit = 0;
7163
7164 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7165 break;
7166 }
7167 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7168
7169 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7170 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7171 if (! event_found)
7172 {
7173 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7174 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7175 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7176 x_noop_count++;
7177 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7178 {
7179 x_noop_count=0;
7180
7181 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7182 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7183
7184 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7185
7186 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7187 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7188 }
7189 }
7190
7191 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7192 raise it now. */
7193 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7194 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7195 {
7196 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7197 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7198 }
7199
7200 unblock_input ();
7201
7202 return count;
7203 }
7204
7205
7206
7207 \f
7208 /***********************************************************************
7209 Text Cursor
7210 ***********************************************************************/
7211
7212 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7213 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7214
7215 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7216 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7217 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7218
7219 static void
7220 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7221 {
7222 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7223 XRectangle clip_rect;
7224 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7225
7226 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7227
7228 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7229 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7230 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7231 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7232 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7233
7234 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7235 }
7236
7237
7238 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7239
7240 static void
7241 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7242 {
7243 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7244 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7245 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7246 int x, y, wd, h;
7247 XGCValues xgcv;
7248 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7249 GC gc;
7250
7251 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7252 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7253 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7254 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7255 return;
7256
7257 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7258 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7259 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7260
7261 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7262 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7263 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7264 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7265 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7266 else
7267 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7268 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7269 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7270
7271 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7272 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7273 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7274 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7275 }
7276
7277
7278 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7279
7280 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7281 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7282 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7283 --gerd. */
7284
7285 static void
7286 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7287 {
7288 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7289 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7290
7291 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7292 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7293 and mini-buffer. */
7294 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7295 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7296 return;
7297
7298 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7299 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7300 the bar might not be in the window. */
7301 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7302 {
7303 struct glyph_row *r;
7304 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7305 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7306 }
7307 else
7308 {
7309 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7310 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7311 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7312 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7313 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7314 XGCValues xgcv;
7315
7316 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7317 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7318 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7319 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7320 that the glyph is legible. */
7321 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7322 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7323 else
7324 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7325 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7326
7327 if (gc)
7328 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7329 else
7330 {
7331 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7332 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7333 }
7334
7335 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7336
7337 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7338 {
7339 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7340
7341 if (width < 0)
7342 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7343 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7344
7345 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7346
7347 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7348 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7349 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7350 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7351
7352 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7353 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7354 width, row->height);
7355 }
7356 else
7357 {
7358 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7359
7360 if (width < 0)
7361 width = row->height;
7362
7363 width = min (row->height, width);
7364
7365 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7366 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7367
7368 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7369 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7370 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7371 row->height - width),
7372 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7373 }
7374
7375 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7376 }
7377 }
7378
7379
7380 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7381
7382 static void
7383 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7384 {
7385 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7386 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7387 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7388 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7389 }
7390
7391
7392 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7393
7394 static void
7395 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7396 {
7397 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7398 x, y, width, height, False);
7399 #ifdef USE_GTK
7400 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7401 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7402 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7403 #endif
7404 }
7405
7406
7407 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7408
7409 static void
7410 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7411 {
7412 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7413
7414 if (on_p)
7415 {
7416 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7417 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7418
7419 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7420 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7421 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7422 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7423 {
7424 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7425 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7426 }
7427 else
7428 {
7429 switch (cursor_type)
7430 {
7431 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7432 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7433 break;
7434
7435 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7436 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7437 break;
7438
7439 case BAR_CURSOR:
7440 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7441 break;
7442
7443 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7444 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7445 break;
7446
7447 case NO_CURSOR:
7448 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7449 break;
7450
7451 default:
7452 emacs_abort ();
7453 }
7454 }
7455
7456 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7457 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7458 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7459 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7460 #endif
7461 }
7462
7463 #ifndef XFlush
7464 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7465 #endif
7466 }
7467
7468 \f
7469 /* Icons. */
7470
7471 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7472
7473 int
7474 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7475 {
7476 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
7477
7478 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7479 return 1;
7480
7481 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7482 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7483 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7484 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7485
7486 if (STRINGP (file))
7487 {
7488 #ifdef USE_GTK
7489 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7490 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7491 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7492 return 0;
7493 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7494 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7495 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7496 }
7497 else
7498 {
7499 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7500 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7501 {
7502 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
7503
7504 #ifdef USE_GTK
7505
7506 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7507 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7508 return 0;
7509
7510 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7511
7512 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7513 if (rc != -1)
7514 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7515
7516 #endif
7517
7518 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7519 if (rc == -1)
7520 {
7521 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7522 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7523 if (rc == -1)
7524 return 1;
7525
7526 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7527 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7528 }
7529 }
7530
7531 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7532 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7533 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7534 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7535 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7536
7537 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7538 }
7539
7540 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7541 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7542
7543 return 0;
7544 }
7545
7546
7547 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7548 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7549
7550 int
7551 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7552 {
7553 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7554 return 1;
7555
7556 {
7557 XTextProperty text;
7558 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7559 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7560 text.format = 8;
7561 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7562 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7563 }
7564
7565 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7566 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7567 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7568 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7569
7570 return 0;
7571 }
7572 \f
7573 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7574
7575 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7576 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7577
7578 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7579 be called from a signal handler.
7580 */
7581
7582 struct x_error_message_stack {
7583 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7584 Display *dpy;
7585 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7586 };
7587 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7588
7589 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7590 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7591 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7592
7593 static void
7594 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7595 {
7596 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7597 x_error_message->string,
7598 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7599 }
7600
7601 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7602 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7603 operating on.
7604
7605 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7606 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7607 stored in *x_error_message.
7608
7609 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7610 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7611
7612 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7613
7614 void
7615 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7616 {
7617 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof *data);
7618
7619 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7620 XSync (dpy, False);
7621
7622 data->dpy = dpy;
7623 data->string[0] = 0;
7624 data->prev = x_error_message;
7625 x_error_message = data;
7626 }
7627
7628 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7629 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7630
7631 void
7632 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7633 {
7634 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7635
7636 block_input ();
7637
7638 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7639 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7640 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7641 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7642
7643 tmp = x_error_message;
7644 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7645 xfree (tmp);
7646 unblock_input ();
7647 }
7648
7649 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7650 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7651 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7652
7653 void
7654 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7655 {
7656 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7657 XSync (dpy, False);
7658
7659 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7660 {
7661 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7662 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7663 x_uncatch_errors ();
7664 error (format, string);
7665 }
7666 }
7667
7668 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7669 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7670
7671 int
7672 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7673 {
7674 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7675 XSync (dpy, False);
7676
7677 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7678 }
7679
7680 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7681
7682 void
7683 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7684 {
7685 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7686 }
7687
7688 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7689 * idea. --lorentey */
7690 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7691
7692 void
7693 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7694 {
7695 while (x_error_message)
7696 x_uncatch_errors ();
7697 }
7698 #endif
7699
7700 #if 0
7701 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7702 x_trace_wire (void)
7703 {
7704 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7705 }
7706 #endif /* ! 0 */
7707
7708 \f
7709 /************************************************************************
7710 Handling X errors
7711 ************************************************************************/
7712
7713 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7714
7715 static char *error_msg;
7716
7717 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7718 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7719
7720 static void
7721 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7722 {
7723 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7724 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7725 ptrdiff_t idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7726
7727 error_msg = alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7728 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7729
7730 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7731 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7732
7733 if (dpyinfo)
7734 {
7735 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7736 frame on it. */
7737 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7738 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7739 }
7740
7741 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7742 that are on the dead display. */
7743 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7744 {
7745 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7746 minibuf_frame
7747 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7748 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7749 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7750 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7751 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7752 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7753 }
7754
7755 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7756 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7757 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7758 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7759 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7760 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7761 {
7762 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7763 trying to find a replacement. */
7764 kset_default_minibuffer_frame (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Qt);
7765 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7766 }
7767
7768 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7769 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7770 if (dpyinfo)
7771 {
7772 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7773 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7774 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7775 #ifdef USE_GTK
7776 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7777 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7778 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7779 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7780 shut_down_emacs (0, Qnil);
7781 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7782 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7783 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7784 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7785 error_msg);
7786 emacs_abort ();
7787 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7788
7789 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7790 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7791
7792 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7793 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7794 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7795 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7796 emacs_abort ();
7797
7798 {
7799 Lisp_Object tmp;
7800 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7801 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7802 }
7803 }
7804
7805 if (terminal_list == 0)
7806 {
7807 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7808 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7809 /* NOTREACHED */
7810 }
7811
7812 totally_unblock_input ();
7813
7814 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7815 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7816
7817 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7818 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7819
7820 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7821 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7822 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7823 error ("%s", error_msg);
7824 }
7825
7826 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7827 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7828 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7829
7830 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7831 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7832
7833 static int
7834 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7835 {
7836 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
7837 if (event->error_code == BadMatch
7838 && event->request_code == X_SetInputFocus
7839 && event->minor_code == 0)
7840 {
7841 return 0;
7842 }
7843 #endif
7844
7845 if (x_error_message)
7846 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7847 else
7848 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7849 return 0;
7850 }
7851
7852 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7853 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7854 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7855
7856 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7857
7858 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7859 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7860
7861 static void NO_INLINE
7862 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7863 {
7864 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7865
7866 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7867 or colors that are not defined. */
7868
7869 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7870 return;
7871
7872 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7873 original error handler. */
7874
7875 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7876 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7877 buf, event->request_code);
7878 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7879 }
7880
7881
7882 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7883 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7884 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7885
7886 static int
7887 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7888 {
7889 char buf[256];
7890
7891 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
7892 DisplayString (display));
7893 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7894 return 0;
7895 }
7896 \f
7897 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7898
7899 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7900 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7901 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7902 FONT-OBJECT. */
7903
7904 Lisp_Object
7905 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7906 {
7907 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7908
7909 if (fontset < 0)
7910 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7911 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7912 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7913 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7914 do. */
7915 return font_object;
7916
7917 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7918 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7919 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7920 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
7921 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7922
7923 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7924
7925 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7926 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7927 {
7928 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7929 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7930 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7931 }
7932 else
7933 {
7934 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7935 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7936 }
7937
7938 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7939 {
7940 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7941 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7942 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7943 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7944 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7945 }
7946
7947 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7948 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7949 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7950 {
7951 block_input ();
7952 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7953 unblock_input ();
7954 }
7955 #endif
7956
7957 return font_object;
7958 }
7959
7960 \f
7961 /***********************************************************************
7962 X Input Methods
7963 ***********************************************************************/
7964
7965 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7966
7967 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7968
7969 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7970 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7971 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7972
7973 static void
7974 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7975 {
7976 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7977 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7978
7979 block_input ();
7980
7981 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7982 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7983 {
7984 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7985 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7986 {
7987 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7988 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7989 }
7990 }
7991
7992 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7993 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7994 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7995 unblock_input ();
7996 }
7997
7998 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7999
8000 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8001 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8002 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
8003 #endif
8004
8005 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8006 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8007
8008 static void
8009 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8010 {
8011 XIM xim;
8012
8013 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8014 if (use_xim)
8015 {
8016 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8017 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8018 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8019 emacs_class);
8020 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8021
8022 if (xim)
8023 {
8024 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8025 XIMCallback destroy;
8026 #endif
8027
8028 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8029 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8030
8031 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8032 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8033 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8034 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8035 #endif
8036 }
8037 }
8038
8039 else
8040 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8041 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8042 }
8043
8044
8045 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8046
8047 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8048 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8049 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8050 when the callback was registered. */
8051
8052 static void
8053 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8054 {
8055 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8056 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8057
8058 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8059 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8060 return;
8061
8062 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8063
8064 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8065 as they have no XIC. */
8066 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8067 {
8068 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8069
8070 block_input ();
8071 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8072 {
8073 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8074
8075 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8076 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8077 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8078 {
8079 create_frame_xic (f);
8080 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8081 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8082 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8083 {
8084 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8085 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8086 }
8087 }
8088 }
8089
8090 unblock_input ();
8091 }
8092 }
8093
8094 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8095
8096
8097 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8098 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8099 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8100 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8101
8102 static void
8103 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8104 {
8105 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8106 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8107 if (use_xim)
8108 {
8109 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8110 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = xmalloc (sizeof *xim_inst);
8111 ptrdiff_t len;
8112
8113 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8114 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8115 len = strlen (resource_name);
8116 xim_inst->resource_name = xmalloc (len + 1);
8117 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8118 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8119 resource_name, emacs_class,
8120 xim_instantiate_callback,
8121 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8122 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8123 least, hence the configure test. */
8124 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8125 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8126 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8127 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8128 }
8129 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8130 }
8131
8132
8133 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8134
8135 static void
8136 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8137 {
8138 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8139 if (use_xim)
8140 {
8141 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8142 if (dpyinfo->display)
8143 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8144 NULL, emacs_class,
8145 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8146 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8147 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8148 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8149 if (dpyinfo->display)
8150 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8151 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8152 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8153 }
8154 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8155 }
8156
8157 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8158
8159
8160 \f
8161 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8162 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8163
8164 static void
8165 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8166 {
8167 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8168
8169 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8170 is already for the top-left corner. */
8171 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8172 return;
8173
8174 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8175 position that fits on the screen. */
8176 if (flags & XNegative)
8177 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8178 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8179
8180 {
8181 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8182
8183 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8184 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8185 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8186
8187 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8188 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8189 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8190 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8191 is right, though.
8192
8193 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8194 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8195
8196 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8197 #endif
8198
8199 if (flags & YNegative)
8200 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8201 - height + f->top_pos;
8202 }
8203
8204 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8205 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8206 so the flags should correspond. */
8207 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8208 }
8209
8210 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8211 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8212 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8213 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8214 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8215
8216 void
8217 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8218 {
8219 int modified_top, modified_left;
8220
8221 if (change_gravity > 0)
8222 {
8223 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8224 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8225
8226 f->top_pos = yoff;
8227 f->left_pos = xoff;
8228 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8229 if (xoff < 0)
8230 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8231 if (yoff < 0)
8232 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8233 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8234 }
8235 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8236
8237 block_input ();
8238 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8239
8240 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8241 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8242
8243 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8244 {
8245 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8246 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8247 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8248 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8249 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8250 }
8251
8252 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8253 modified_left, modified_top);
8254
8255 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8256 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8257 ? 1 : 0);
8258
8259 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8260 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8261 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8262 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8263 of the frame.
8264
8265 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8266 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8267 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8268
8269 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8270 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8271 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8272 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8273 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8274 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8275
8276 unblock_input ();
8277 }
8278
8279 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8280 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8281 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8282 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8283 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8284
8285 static int
8286 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8287 {
8288 Atom actual_type;
8289 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8290 int i, rc, actual_format;
8291 Window wmcheck_window;
8292 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8293 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8294 long max_len = 65536;
8295 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8296 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8297 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8298
8299 block_input ();
8300
8301 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8302 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8303 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8304 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8305 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8306 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8307
8308 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8309 {
8310 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8311 x_uncatch_errors ();
8312 unblock_input ();
8313 return 0;
8314 }
8315
8316 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8317 XFree (tmp_data);
8318
8319 /* Check if window exists. */
8320 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8321 x_sync (f);
8322 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8323 {
8324 x_uncatch_errors ();
8325 unblock_input ();
8326 return 0;
8327 }
8328
8329 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8330 {
8331 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8332 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8333 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8334 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8335 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8336 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8337
8338 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8339 tmp_data = NULL;
8340 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8341 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8342 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8343 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8344 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8345
8346 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8347 {
8348 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8349 x_uncatch_errors ();
8350 unblock_input ();
8351 return 0;
8352 }
8353
8354 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8355 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8356 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8357 }
8358
8359 rc = 0;
8360
8361 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8362 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8363
8364 x_uncatch_errors ();
8365 unblock_input ();
8366
8367 return rc;
8368 }
8369
8370 static void
8371 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8372 {
8373 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8374
8375 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8376 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8377 make_number (32),
8378 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8379 Fcons
8380 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8381 Fcons
8382 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8383 value != 0
8384 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8385 : Qnil)));
8386 }
8387
8388 void
8389 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8390 {
8391 Lisp_Object frame;
8392 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8393
8394 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8395
8396 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8397 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8398 }
8399
8400 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8401 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8402 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not.
8403
8404 Return non-zero if we are not hidden, zero if we are. */
8405
8406 static int
8407 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8408 Window window,
8409 int *size_state,
8410 int *sticky)
8411 {
8412 Atom actual_type;
8413 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8414 int i, rc, actual_format, is_hidden = 0;
8415 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8416 long max_len = 65536;
8417 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8418 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8419 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8420
8421 *sticky = 0;
8422 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8423
8424 block_input ();
8425 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8426 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8427 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8428 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8429 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8430
8431 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8432 {
8433 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8434 x_uncatch_errors ();
8435 unblock_input ();
8436 return ! f->iconified;
8437 }
8438
8439 x_uncatch_errors ();
8440
8441 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8442 {
8443 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8444 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
8445 {
8446 is_hidden = 1;
8447 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 1;
8448 }
8449 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8450 {
8451 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8452 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8453 else
8454 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8455 }
8456 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8457 {
8458 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8459 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8460 else
8461 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8462 }
8463 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8464 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8465 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8466 *sticky = 1;
8467 }
8468
8469 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8470 unblock_input ();
8471 return ! is_hidden;
8472 }
8473
8474 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8475
8476 static int
8477 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8478 {
8479 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8480 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8481 int cur, dummy;
8482
8483 (void)get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8484
8485 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8486 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8487 if (!have_net_atom)
8488 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8489
8490 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8491 {
8492 Lisp_Object frame;
8493
8494 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8495
8496 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8497 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8498 are sent at once. */
8499 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8500 {
8501 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8502 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8503 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8504 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8505 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8506 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8507 break;
8508 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8509 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8510 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8511 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8512 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8513 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8514 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8515 break;
8516 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8517 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8518 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8519 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8520 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8521 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8522 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8523 break;
8524 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8525 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8526 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8527 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8528 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8529 break;
8530 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8531 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8532 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8533 else
8534 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8535 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8536 }
8537
8538 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8539
8540 }
8541
8542 return have_net_atom;
8543 }
8544
8545 static void
8546 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8547 {
8548 if (f->async_visible)
8549 {
8550 block_input ();
8551 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8552 x_sync (f);
8553 unblock_input ();
8554 }
8555 }
8556
8557
8558 static int
8559 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8560 {
8561 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8562 Lisp_Object lval;
8563 int sticky = 0;
8564 int not_hidden = get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8565
8566 lval = Qnil;
8567 switch (value)
8568 {
8569 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8570 lval = Qfullwidth;
8571 break;
8572 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8573 lval = Qfullheight;
8574 break;
8575 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8576 lval = Qfullboth;
8577 break;
8578 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8579 lval = Qmaximized;
8580 break;
8581 }
8582
8583 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8584 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8585
8586 return not_hidden;
8587 }
8588
8589 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8590 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8591 static void
8592 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8593 {
8594 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8595 return;
8596
8597 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8598 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8599
8600 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8601 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8602 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8603
8604 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8605 {
8606 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8607 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8608
8609 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8610 {
8611 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8612 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8613 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8614 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8615 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8616 break;
8617 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8618 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8619 break;
8620 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8621 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8622 }
8623
8624 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8625 width, height);
8626 }
8627 }
8628
8629 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8630 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8631 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8632 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8633 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8634 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8635 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8636
8637 static void
8638 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8639 {
8640 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8641
8642 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8643 window manager window around the frame. */
8644
8645 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8646
8647 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8648 {
8649 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8650
8651 int adjusted_left;
8652 int adjusted_top;
8653
8654 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8655 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8656 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8657
8658 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8659
8660 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8661 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8662
8663 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8664 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8665
8666 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8667 }
8668 else
8669 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8670 frame's position. */
8671
8672 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8673 }
8674
8675
8676 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8677 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8678 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8679 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8680 of an exact comparison. */
8681
8682 static void
8683 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8684 {
8685 int count = 0;
8686
8687 while (count++ < 50)
8688 {
8689 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8690
8691 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8692 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8693 loop. */
8694
8695 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8696 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8697
8698 if (fuzzy)
8699 {
8700 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8701 pixels. */
8702
8703 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8704 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8705 return;
8706 }
8707 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8708 return;
8709 }
8710
8711 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8712 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8713
8714 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8715 }
8716
8717
8718 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8719 void
8720 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8721 {
8722 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8723
8724 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8725 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8726 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8727
8728 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8729 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8730
8731 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
8732 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8733 tmo = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
8734 tmo_at = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), tmo);
8735
8736 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8737 {
8738 pending_signals = 1;
8739 totally_unblock_input ();
8740 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8741 block_input ();
8742 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8743
8744 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8745 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8746
8747 time_now = current_emacs_time ();
8748 if (EMACS_TIME_LT (tmo_at, time_now))
8749 break;
8750
8751 tmo = sub_emacs_time (tmo_at, time_now);
8752 if (pselect (fd + 1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo, NULL) == 0)
8753 break; /* Timeout */
8754 }
8755 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8756 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8757 }
8758
8759
8760 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8761 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8762 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8763 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8764
8765 static void
8766 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8767 {
8768 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8769
8770 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8771 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8772 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8773 ? 0
8774 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8775
8776 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8777
8778 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8779 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8780 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8781 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8782
8783 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8784 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8785 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8786 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8787
8788
8789 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8790 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8791 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8792 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8793 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8794
8795 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8796 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8797 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8798 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8799
8800 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8801 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8802 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8803 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8804 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8805
8806 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8807 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8808
8809 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8810 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8811 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8812 if (f->async_visible)
8813 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8814 else
8815 {
8816 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8817 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8818 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8819 x_sync (f);
8820 }
8821 }
8822
8823
8824 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8825 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8826 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8827 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8828
8829 void
8830 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8831 {
8832 block_input ();
8833
8834 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8835 {
8836 int r, c;
8837
8838 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8839 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8840 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8841 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8842 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8843 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8844 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8845 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8846 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8847 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8848 is however. */
8849 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8850 #endif
8851 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8852 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8853 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8854 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8855 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8856 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8857 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8858 }
8859
8860 #ifdef USE_GTK
8861 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8862 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8863 else
8864 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8865 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8866
8867 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8868
8869 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8870
8871 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8872 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8873
8874 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8875 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8876 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8877 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8878 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8879
8880 unblock_input ();
8881 }
8882 \f
8883 /* Mouse warping. */
8884
8885 void
8886 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8887 {
8888 int pix_x, pix_y;
8889
8890 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8891 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8892
8893 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8894 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8895
8896 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8897 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8898
8899 block_input ();
8900
8901 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8902 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8903 unblock_input ();
8904 }
8905
8906 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8907
8908 void
8909 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8910 {
8911 block_input ();
8912
8913 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8914 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8915 unblock_input ();
8916 }
8917 \f
8918 /* Raise frame F. */
8919
8920 void
8921 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8922 {
8923 block_input ();
8924 if (f->async_visible)
8925 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8926
8927 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8928 unblock_input ();
8929 }
8930
8931 /* Lower frame F. */
8932
8933 static void
8934 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8935 {
8936 if (f->async_visible)
8937 {
8938 block_input ();
8939 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8940 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8941 unblock_input ();
8942 }
8943 }
8944
8945 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
8946
8947 void
8948 xembed_request_focus (FRAME_PTR f)
8949 {
8950 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
8951 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
8952 if (f->async_visible)
8953 xembed_send_message (f, CurrentTime,
8954 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
8955 }
8956
8957 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8958
8959 void
8960 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
8961 {
8962 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8963 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8964
8965 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8966 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
8967 {
8968 Lisp_Object frame;
8969 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8970 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8971 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
8972 make_number (32),
8973 Fcons (make_number (1),
8974 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
8975 Qnil)));
8976 }
8977 }
8978
8979 static void
8980 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
8981 {
8982 if (raise_flag)
8983 x_raise_frame (f);
8984 else
8985 x_lower_frame (f);
8986 }
8987 \f
8988 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8989
8990 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
8991
8992 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8993
8994 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
8995
8996 static void
8997 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
8998 {
8999 unsigned long data[2];
9000 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9001
9002 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
9003 data[1] = flags;
9004
9005 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9006 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
9007 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
9008 }
9009 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
9010
9011 static void
9012 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
9013 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
9014 {
9015 XEvent event;
9016
9017 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9018 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9019 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9020 event.xclient.format = 32;
9021 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
9022 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
9023 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9024 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9025 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9026
9027 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9028 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9029 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9030 }
9031 \f
9032 /* Change of visibility. */
9033
9034 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9035 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9036 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9037 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9038 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9039 finishes with it. */
9040
9041 void
9042 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9043 {
9044 Lisp_Object type;
9045 int original_top, original_left;
9046 int retry_count = 2;
9047
9048 retry:
9049
9050 block_input ();
9051
9052 type = x_icon_type (f);
9053 if (!NILP (type))
9054 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9055
9056 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9057 {
9058 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9059 call x_set_offset a second time
9060 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9061 before the window gets really visible. */
9062 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9063 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9064 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9065 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9066
9067 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9068
9069 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9070 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9071 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9072 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9073 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9074 else
9075 {
9076 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9077 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9078 }
9079 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9080 #ifdef USE_GTK
9081 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9082 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9083 #else
9084 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9085 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9086 else
9087 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9088 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9089 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9090 }
9091
9092 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9093
9094 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9095 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9096 so that incoming events are handled. */
9097 {
9098 Lisp_Object frame;
9099 int count;
9100 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9101 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9102 will set it when they are handled. */
9103 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9104
9105 original_left = f->left_pos;
9106 original_top = f->top_pos;
9107
9108 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9109 unblock_input ();
9110
9111 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9112
9113 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9114 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9115 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9116 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9117
9118 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9119 because the window manager may choose the position
9120 and we don't want to override it. */
9121
9122 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9123 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9124 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9125 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9126 && previously_visible)
9127 {
9128 Drawable rootw;
9129 int x, y;
9130 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9131
9132 block_input ();
9133
9134 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9135 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9136 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9137 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9138 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9139 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9140 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9141 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9142 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9143
9144 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9145 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9146 original_left, original_top);
9147
9148 unblock_input ();
9149 }
9150
9151 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9152
9153 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9154 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9155 MapNotify at all.. */
9156 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9157 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9158 {
9159 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9160 x_sync (f);
9161
9162 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9163 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9164 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9165 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9166 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9167 probably a bug. */
9168 if (input_polling_used ())
9169 {
9170 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9171 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9172 handler reset it. */
9173 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9174 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9175 poll_for_input_1 ();
9176 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9177 }
9178
9179 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9180 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9181 }
9182
9183 /* 2000-09-28: In
9184
9185 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9186 (iconify-frame f)
9187 (raise-frame f))
9188
9189 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9190 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9191 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9192 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9193
9194 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count != 0)
9195 goto retry;
9196 }
9197 }
9198
9199 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9200
9201 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9202
9203 void
9204 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9205 {
9206 Window window;
9207
9208 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9209 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9210
9211 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9212 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9213 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9214
9215 block_input ();
9216
9217 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9218 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9219 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9220 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9221 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9222 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9223
9224 #ifdef USE_GTK
9225 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9226 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9227 else
9228 #else
9229 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9230 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9231 else
9232 #endif
9233 {
9234
9235 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9236 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9237 {
9238 unblock_input ();
9239 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9240 }
9241 }
9242
9243 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9244 just by the event that we get from the server.
9245 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9246 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9247 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9248 f->visible = 0;
9249 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9250 f->async_visible = 0;
9251 f->async_iconified = 0;
9252
9253 x_sync (f);
9254
9255 unblock_input ();
9256 }
9257
9258 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9259
9260 void
9261 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9262 {
9263 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9264 int result;
9265 #endif
9266 Lisp_Object type;
9267
9268 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9269 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9270 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9271
9272 if (f->async_iconified)
9273 return;
9274
9275 block_input ();
9276
9277 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9278
9279 type = x_icon_type (f);
9280 if (!NILP (type))
9281 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9282
9283 #if defined (USE_GTK)
9284 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9285 {
9286 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9287 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9288
9289 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9290 f->iconified = 1;
9291 f->visible = 1;
9292 f->async_iconified = 1;
9293 f->async_visible = 0;
9294 unblock_input ();
9295 return;
9296 }
9297 #endif
9298
9299 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9300
9301 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9302 {
9303 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9304 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9305 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9306 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9307 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9308 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9309 so we have to record it here. */
9310 f->iconified = 1;
9311 f->visible = 1;
9312 f->async_iconified = 1;
9313 f->async_visible = 0;
9314 unblock_input ();
9315 return;
9316 }
9317
9318 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9319 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9320 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9321 unblock_input ();
9322
9323 if (!result)
9324 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9325
9326 f->async_iconified = 1;
9327 f->async_visible = 0;
9328
9329
9330 block_input ();
9331 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9332 unblock_input ();
9333 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9334
9335 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9336 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9337 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9338 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9339 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9340 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9341
9342 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9343 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9344
9345 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9346 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9347 {
9348 XEvent msg;
9349
9350 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9351 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9352 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9353 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9354 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9355
9356 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9357 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9358 False,
9359 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9360 &msg))
9361 {
9362 unblock_input ();
9363 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9364 }
9365 }
9366
9367 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9368 IconicState. */
9369 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9370
9371 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9372 {
9373 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9374 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9375 }
9376
9377 f->async_iconified = 1;
9378 f->async_visible = 0;
9379
9380 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9381 unblock_input ();
9382 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9383 }
9384
9385 \f
9386 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9387
9388 void
9389 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9390 {
9391 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9392 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9393 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9394 Lisp_Object bar;
9395 struct scroll_bar *b;
9396 #endif
9397
9398 block_input ();
9399
9400 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9401 commands to the X server. */
9402 if (dpyinfo->display)
9403 {
9404 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9405 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9406 face. */
9407 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9408 free_frame_faces (f);
9409
9410 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9411 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9412
9413 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9414 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9415 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9416 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9417 toolkit scroll bars. */
9418 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9419 {
9420 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9421 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9422 }
9423 #endif
9424
9425 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9426 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9427 free_frame_xic (f);
9428 #endif
9429
9430 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9431 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9432 {
9433 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9434 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9435 }
9436 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9437 we are using a toolkit. */
9438 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9439 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9440
9441 free_frame_menubar (f);
9442 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9443
9444 #ifdef USE_GTK
9445 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9446 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9447
9448 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9449 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9450 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9451
9452 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9453 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9454 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9455 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9456 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9457 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9458
9459 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9460 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9461 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9462 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9463 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9464 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9465 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9466 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9467 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9468 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9469 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9470 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9471 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9472 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9473 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9474
9475 x_free_gcs (f);
9476 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9477 }
9478
9479 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9480 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9481 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9482
9483 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9484 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9485 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9486 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9487 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9488 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9489
9490 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9491 {
9492 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9493 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9494 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9495 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9496 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9497 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9498 }
9499
9500 unblock_input ();
9501 }
9502
9503
9504 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9505
9506 static void
9507 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9508 {
9509 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9510
9511 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9512 commands to the X server. */
9513 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9514 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9515
9516 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9517 }
9518
9519 \f
9520 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9521
9522 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9523 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9524 that the window now has.
9525 If USER_POSITION, set the USPosition
9526 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9527 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c. */
9528
9529 #ifndef USE_GTK
9530 void
9531 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, bool user_position)
9532 {
9533 XSizeHints size_hints;
9534 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9535
9536 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9537 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9538 {
9539 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f->output_data.x->widget);
9540 return;
9541 }
9542 #endif
9543
9544 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9545 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9546
9547 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9548 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9549
9550 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9551 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9552
9553 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9554 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9555 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9556 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9557 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9558 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9559
9560 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9561 {
9562 int base_width, base_height;
9563 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9564
9565 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9566 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9567
9568 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9569
9570 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9571 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9572 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9573 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9574 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9575
9576 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9577 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9578 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9579
9580 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9581 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9582 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9583 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9584 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9585 }
9586
9587 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9588 if (flags)
9589 {
9590 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9591 goto no_read;
9592 }
9593
9594 {
9595 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9596 long supplied_return;
9597 int value;
9598
9599 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9600 &supplied_return);
9601
9602 if (flags)
9603 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9604 else
9605 {
9606 if (value == 0)
9607 hints.flags = 0;
9608 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9609 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9610 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9611 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9612 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9613 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9614 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9615 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9616 }
9617 }
9618
9619 no_read:
9620
9621 #ifdef PWinGravity
9622 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9623 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9624
9625 if (user_position)
9626 {
9627 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9628 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9629 }
9630 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9631
9632 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9633 }
9634 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9635
9636 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9637
9638 static void
9639 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9640 {
9641 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9642 Arg al[1];
9643
9644 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9645 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9646 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9647 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9648
9649 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9650 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9651
9652 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9653 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9654 }
9655
9656 static void
9657 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
9658 {
9659 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9660
9661 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9662 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9663 #endif
9664
9665 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9666 {
9667 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9668 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9669 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9670 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9671 }
9672 else
9673 {
9674 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9675 pixmap. */
9676 return;
9677 }
9678
9679
9680 #ifdef USE_GTK
9681 {
9682 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9683 return;
9684 }
9685
9686 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9687
9688 {
9689 Arg al[1];
9690 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9691 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9692 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9693 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9694 }
9695
9696 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9697
9698 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9699 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9700
9701 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9702 }
9703
9704 void
9705 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9706 {
9707 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9708
9709 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9710 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9711 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9712
9713 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9714 }
9715
9716 \f
9717 /***********************************************************************
9718 Fonts
9719 ***********************************************************************/
9720
9721 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
9722
9723 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9724 font table. */
9725
9726 static void
9727 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9728 {
9729 eassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9730 if (font->driver->check)
9731 eassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9732 }
9733
9734 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
9735
9736 \f
9737 /***********************************************************************
9738 Initialization
9739 ***********************************************************************/
9740
9741 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9742 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9743 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9744 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9745
9746 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9747 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9748 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9749
9750 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9751 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9752 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9753 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9754 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9755 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9756 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9757 };
9758
9759 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9760
9761 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9762
9763 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9764
9765 static int x_initialized;
9766
9767 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9768 the screen number from the server number. */
9769 static int
9770 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9771 {
9772 int seen_colon = 0;
9773 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9774 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (Vsystem_name);
9775 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
9776
9777 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9778 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9779 length_until_period++;
9780
9781 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9782 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9783 name1 += 4;
9784 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9785 name2 += 4;
9786 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9787 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9788 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9789 name1 += system_name_length;
9790 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9791 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9792 name2 += system_name_length;
9793 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9794 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9795 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9796 name1 += length_until_period;
9797 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9798 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9799 name2 += length_until_period;
9800
9801 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9802 {
9803 if (*name1 == ':')
9804 seen_colon = 1;
9805 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9806 return 1;
9807 }
9808 return (seen_colon
9809 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9810 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9811 }
9812
9813 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9814 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9815 to 5. */
9816 static void
9817 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9818 {
9819 int nr = 0;
9820 int off = 0;
9821
9822 while (!(mask & 1))
9823 {
9824 off++;
9825 mask >>= 1;
9826 }
9827
9828 while (mask & 1)
9829 {
9830 nr++;
9831 mask >>= 1;
9832 }
9833
9834 *offset = off;
9835 *bits = nr;
9836 }
9837
9838 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9839 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9840
9841 int
9842 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9843 {
9844 int dpy_ok = 1;
9845 Display *dpy;
9846
9847 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9848 if (dpy)
9849 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9850 else
9851 dpy_ok = 0;
9852 return dpy_ok;
9853 }
9854
9855 #ifdef USE_GTK
9856 static void
9857 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9858 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9859 {
9860 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9861 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9862 }
9863 #endif
9864
9865 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9866 the structure that describes the open display.
9867 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9868
9869 struct x_display_info *
9870 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9871 {
9872 int connection;
9873 Display *dpy;
9874 struct terminal *terminal;
9875 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9876 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9877 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9878 ptrdiff_t lim;
9879
9880 block_input ();
9881
9882 if (!x_initialized)
9883 {
9884 x_initialize ();
9885 ++x_initialized;
9886 }
9887
9888 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9889 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9890
9891 #ifdef USE_GTK
9892 {
9893 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9894 int argc;
9895 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9896 char **argv2 = argv;
9897 guint id;
9898
9899 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9900 {
9901 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9902 }
9903 else
9904 {
9905 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9906 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9907
9908 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9909 argv[argc] = 0;
9910
9911 argc = 0;
9912 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9913
9914 if (! NILP (display_name))
9915 {
9916 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9917 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
9918 }
9919
9920 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9921 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9922
9923 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9924
9925 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
9926 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
9927 {
9928 static char fix_events[] = "GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1";
9929 putenv (fix_events);
9930 }
9931
9932 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9933 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9934 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9935 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9936
9937 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
9938 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
9939 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9940
9941 /* gtk_init does set_locale. Fix locale before and after. */
9942 fixup_locale ();
9943 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9944 fixup_locale ();
9945
9946 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9947
9948 xg_initialize ();
9949
9950 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
9951
9952 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION <= 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION <= 90
9953 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9954 {
9955 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9956 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9957
9958 s = build_string (file);
9959 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9960
9961 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9962 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
9963 }
9964 #endif
9965
9966 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9967 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9968 }
9969 }
9970 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9971 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9972 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9973 errors with X11R5:
9974 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9975 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9976 So let's not use it until R6. */
9977 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9978 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
9979 #endif
9980
9981 {
9982 int argc = 0;
9983 char *argv[3];
9984
9985 argv[0] = "";
9986 argc = 1;
9987 if (xrm_option)
9988 {
9989 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
9990 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
9991 }
9992 turn_on_atimers (0);
9993 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
9994 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
9995 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
9996 &argc, argv);
9997 turn_on_atimers (1);
9998
9999 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10000 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10001 fixup_locale ();
10002 #endif
10003 }
10004
10005 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10006 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10007 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
10008 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10009 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10010
10011 /* Detect failure. */
10012 if (dpy == 0)
10013 {
10014 unblock_input ();
10015 return 0;
10016 }
10017
10018 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10019
10020 dpyinfo = xzalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo);
10021 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
10022
10023 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10024
10025 {
10026 struct x_display_info *share;
10027 Lisp_Object tail;
10028
10029 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10030 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10031 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10032 SSDATA (display_name)))
10033 break;
10034 if (share)
10035 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10036 else
10037 {
10038 terminal->kboard = xmalloc (sizeof *terminal->kboard);
10039 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10040 kset_window_system (terminal->kboard, Qx);
10041
10042 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10043 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10044 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10045 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10046 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10047
10048 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10049 {
10050 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10051
10052 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10053 list of terminals. */
10054 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10055 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10056 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10057 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10058
10059 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10060 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10061 unblock_input ();
10062 kset_system_key_alist
10063 (terminal->kboard,
10064 call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10065 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string));
10066 block_input ();
10067 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10068 terminal_list = terminal;
10069 UNGCPRO;
10070 }
10071
10072 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10073 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10074 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10075 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10076 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10077 }
10078 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10079 }
10080
10081 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10082 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10083 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10084
10085 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10086 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10087 x_display_name_list);
10088 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10089
10090 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10091
10092 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10093 terminal->name = xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10094 memcpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10095 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10096
10097 #if 0
10098 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10099 #endif /* ! 0 */
10100
10101 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
10102 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name))
10103 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
10104 dpyinfo->x_id_name = xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10105 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name) + 2);
10106 strcat (strcat (strcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, SSDATA (Vinvocation_name)), "@"),
10107 SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10108
10109 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10110 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10111
10112 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10113 #ifdef USE_GTK
10114 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10115 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10116 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10117
10118 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10119 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10120
10121 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10122 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10123 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10124 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10125 #else
10126 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10127 #endif
10128 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10129 all versions. */
10130 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10131
10132 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10133 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10134 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10135 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10136 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10137 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10138 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10139 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10140 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10141 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10142 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10143 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10144 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10145 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10146 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10147 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10148 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10149 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10150 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10151 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10152 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10153 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10154 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10155 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10156 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10157 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10158 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10159
10160 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10161 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10162 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10163
10164 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10165 {
10166 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10167 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10168 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10169 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10170 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10171 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10172 }
10173
10174 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10175 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10176 {
10177 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10178 {
10179 Lisp_Object value;
10180 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10181 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10182 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10183 Qnil, Qnil);
10184 if (STRINGP (value)
10185 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10186 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10187 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10188 }
10189 }
10190 else
10191 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10192 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10193
10194 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10195 {
10196 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10197 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10198 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10199 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10200 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10201 for example). */
10202 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10203 double d;
10204 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10205 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10206 }
10207 #endif
10208
10209 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10210 {
10211 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10212 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10213 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10214 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10215 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10216 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10217 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10218 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10219 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10220 }
10221
10222 {
10223 const struct
10224 {
10225 const char *name;
10226 Atom *atom;
10227 } atom_refs[] = {
10228 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10229 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10230 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10231 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10232 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10233 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10234 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10235 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10236 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10237 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10238 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10239 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10240 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10241 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10242 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10243 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10244 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10245 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10246 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10247 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10248 { "ATOM", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM },
10249 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10250 { "CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER },
10251 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10252 /* For properties of font. */
10253 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10254 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10255 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10256 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10257 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10258 /* Ghostscript support. */
10259 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10260 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10261 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10262 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10263 /* EWMH */
10264 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10265 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10266 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10267 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10268 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10269 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10270 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10271 { "_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden },
10272 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10273 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10274 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10275 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10276 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10277 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10278 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10279 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10280 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10281 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10282 /* Session management */
10283 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10284 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10285 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10286 };
10287
10288 int i;
10289 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10290 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10291 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10292 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atoms_return);
10293 char **atom_names = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atom_names);
10294 static char const xsettings_fmt[] = "_XSETTINGS_S%d";
10295 char xsettings_atom_name[sizeof xsettings_fmt - 2
10296 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int)];
10297
10298 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10299 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10300
10301 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10302 sprintf (xsettings_atom_name, xsettings_fmt,
10303 XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10304 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10305
10306 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10307 False, atoms_return);
10308
10309 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10310 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10311
10312 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10313 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10314
10315 xfree (atom_names);
10316 xfree (atoms_return);
10317 }
10318
10319 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10320 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10321 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms
10322 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10323
10324 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10325 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10326 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10327
10328 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10329 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10330 dpyinfo->gray
10331 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10332 gray_bits, gray_width, gray_height,
10333 1, 0, 1);
10334
10335 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10336 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10337 #endif
10338
10339 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10340
10341 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10342 if (connection != 0)
10343 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10344
10345 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10346 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10347 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10348
10349 if (interrupt_input)
10350 init_sigio (connection);
10351
10352 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10353 {
10354 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10355 Font font;
10356
10357 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10358 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10359 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10360 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10361 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10362 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10363 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10364 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10365 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10366 emacs_abort ();
10367 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10368 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10369 x_uncatch_errors ();
10370 }
10371 #endif
10372
10373 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10374 for debugging X code. */
10375 {
10376 Lisp_Object value;
10377 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10378 build_string ("synchronous"),
10379 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10380 Qnil, Qnil);
10381 if (STRINGP (value)
10382 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10383 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10384 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10385 }
10386
10387 {
10388 Lisp_Object value;
10389 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10390 build_string ("useXIM"),
10391 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10392 Qnil, Qnil);
10393 #ifdef USE_XIM
10394 if (STRINGP (value)
10395 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10396 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10397 use_xim = 0;
10398 #else
10399 if (STRINGP (value)
10400 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10401 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10402 use_xim = 1;
10403 #endif
10404 }
10405
10406 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10407 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10408 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10409 tty. */
10410 if (terminal->id == 1)
10411 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10412 #endif
10413
10414 unblock_input ();
10415
10416 return dpyinfo;
10417 }
10418 \f
10419 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10420 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10421
10422 static void
10423 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10424 {
10425 struct terminal *t;
10426
10427 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10428 X display. */
10429 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10430 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10431 {
10432 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10433 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10434 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10435 x_session_close ();
10436 #endif
10437 delete_terminal (t);
10438 break;
10439 }
10440
10441 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10442
10443 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10444 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10445 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10446 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10447 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10448 else
10449 {
10450 Lisp_Object tail;
10451
10452 tail = x_display_name_list;
10453 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10454 {
10455 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10456 {
10457 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10458 break;
10459 }
10460 tail = XCDR (tail);
10461 }
10462 }
10463
10464 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10465 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10466
10467 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10468 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10469 else
10470 {
10471 struct x_display_info *tail;
10472
10473 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10474 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10475 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10476 }
10477
10478 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10479 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10480 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10481 xfree (dpyinfo);
10482 }
10483
10484 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10485
10486 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10487 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10488 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10489 that slows us down. */
10490
10491 static void
10492 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10493 {
10494 block_input ();
10495 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10496 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10497 {
10498 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10499 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10500 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10501 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10502 }
10503 unblock_input ();
10504 }
10505
10506 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10507 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10508 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10509 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10510 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10511 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10512 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10513
10514 void
10515 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10516 {
10517 block_input ();
10518 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10519 {
10520 EMACS_TIME interval = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
10521 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10522 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10523 }
10524 unblock_input ();
10525 }
10526
10527 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10528
10529 \f
10530 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10531
10532 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10533 {
10534 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10535 x_produce_glyphs,
10536 x_write_glyphs,
10537 x_insert_glyphs,
10538 x_clear_end_of_line,
10539 x_scroll_run,
10540 x_after_update_window_line,
10541 x_update_window_begin,
10542 x_update_window_end,
10543 x_cursor_to,
10544 x_flush,
10545 #ifdef XFlush
10546 x_flush,
10547 #else
10548 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10549 #endif
10550 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10551 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10552 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10553 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10554 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10555 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10556 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10557 x_draw_glyph_string,
10558 x_define_frame_cursor,
10559 x_clear_frame_area,
10560 x_draw_window_cursor,
10561 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10562 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10563 };
10564
10565
10566 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10567 void
10568 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10569 {
10570 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10571
10572 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10573 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10574 if (!terminal->name)
10575 return;
10576
10577 block_input ();
10578 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10579 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10580 X display. */
10581 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10582 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10583 #endif
10584
10585 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10586 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10587 if (dpyinfo->display)
10588 {
10589 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10590 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10591
10592 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10593 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10594 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10595 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10596
10597 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10598 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10599 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10600 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10601 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10602 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10603 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10604 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10605 leaks in other situations. */
10606 #if 0
10607 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10608 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10609 #else
10610 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10611 #endif
10612 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10613 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10614 closing all the displays. */
10615 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10616 #endif
10617
10618 #ifdef USE_GTK
10619 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10620 #else
10621 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10622 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10623 #else
10624 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10625 #endif
10626 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10627 }
10628
10629 /* Mark as dead. */
10630 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10631 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10632 unblock_input ();
10633 }
10634
10635 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10636 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10637
10638 static struct terminal *
10639 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10640 {
10641 struct terminal *terminal;
10642
10643 terminal = create_terminal ();
10644
10645 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10646 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10647 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10648
10649 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10650
10651 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10652 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10653 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10654 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10655 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10656 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10657 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10658 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10659 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10660 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10661 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10662 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10663 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10664 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10665 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10666 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10667 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10668 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10669 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10670 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10671
10672 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10673 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10674
10675 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10676 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10677 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10678 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10679 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10680 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10681 off the bottom. */
10682
10683 return terminal;
10684 }
10685
10686 void
10687 x_initialize (void)
10688 {
10689 baud_rate = 19200;
10690
10691 x_noop_count = 0;
10692 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10693 any_help_event_p = 0;
10694 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10695
10696 #ifdef USE_GTK
10697 current_count = -1;
10698 #endif
10699
10700 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10701 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10702
10703 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10704 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10705
10706 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10707
10708 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10709 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10710 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10711 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10712 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10713 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10714 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10715
10716 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10717 #endif
10718
10719 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10720 #ifndef USE_GTK
10721 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10722 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10723 #endif
10724 #endif
10725
10726 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10727 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10728 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10729
10730 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10731 original error handler. */
10732 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10733 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10734 }
10735
10736
10737 void
10738 syms_of_xterm (void)
10739 {
10740 x_error_message = NULL;
10741
10742 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10743 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10744
10745 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10746 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10747
10748 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
10749 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
10750
10751 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10752 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10753
10754 #ifdef USE_GTK
10755 xg_default_icon_file = build_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10756 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10757
10758 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
10759 #endif
10760
10761 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10762 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10763 doc: /* Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10764 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10765 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10766 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10767 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10768 sizes. */);
10769 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10770
10771 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10772 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10773 doc: /* Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10774 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10775 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10776 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10777 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10778
10779 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10780 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10781 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10782 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10783 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10784 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10785 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10786 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10787 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10788
10789 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10790 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10791 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10792 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10793 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10794 With MS Windows or Nextstep, the value is t. */);
10795 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10796 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10797 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10798 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10799 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10800 #elif USE_GTK
10801 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10802 #else
10803 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10804 #endif
10805 #else
10806 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10807 #endif
10808
10809 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10810 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10811
10812 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10813 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10814 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10815 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10816 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10817 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10818 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10819 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10820 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10821
10822 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10823 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10824 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10825 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10826 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10827 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10828
10829 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10830 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10831 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10832 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10833 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10834 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10835
10836 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10837 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10838 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10839 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10840 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10841 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10842
10843 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10844 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10845 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10846 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10847 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10848 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10849
10850 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10851 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10852 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (hashtest_eql, make_number (900),
10853 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10854 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10855 Qnil);
10856 }
10857
10858 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */